1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2#ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3#define __NET_CFG80211_H 4/* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13#include <linux/netdevice.h> 14#include <linux/debugfs.h> 15#include <linux/list.h> 16#include <linux/bug.h> 17#include <linux/netlink.h> 18#include <linux/skbuff.h> 19#include <linux/nl80211.h> 20#include <linux/if_ether.h> 21#include <linux/ieee80211.h> 22#include <linux/net.h> 23#include <net/regulatory.h> 24 25/** 26 * DOC: Introduction 27 * 28 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 29 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 30 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 31 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 32 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 33 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 34 * 35 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 36 * use restrictions. 37 */ 38 39 40/** 41 * DOC: Device registration 42 * 43 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 44 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 45 * described below. 46 * 47 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 48 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 49 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 50 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 51 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 52 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 53 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 54 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 55 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 56 * 57 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 58 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 59 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 60 */ 61 62struct wiphy; 63 64/* 65 * wireless hardware capability structures 66 */ 67 68/** 69 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 70 * 71 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 72 * 73 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 74 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 75 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 78 * is not permitted. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 80 * is not permitted. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 83 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 84 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 85 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 86 * restrictions. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 93 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 94 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 95 * on this channel. 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 97 * on this channel. 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 104 * on this channel. 105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 106 * on this channel. 107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 108 * on this channel. 109 * 110 */ 111enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 112 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 113 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 114 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 116 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 117 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 131}; 132 133#define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 134 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 135 136#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 137#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 138 139/** 140 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 141 * 142 * This structure describes a single channel for use 143 * with cfg80211. 144 * 145 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 146 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 147 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 148 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 149 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 150 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 151 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 152 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 153 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 154 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 155 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 156 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 157 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 158 * @orig_mag: internal use 159 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 160 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 161 * on this channel. 162 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 163 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 164 */ 165struct ieee80211_channel { 166 enum nl80211_band band; 167 u32 center_freq; 168 u16 freq_offset; 169 u16 hw_value; 170 u32 flags; 171 int max_antenna_gain; 172 int max_power; 173 int max_reg_power; 174 bool beacon_found; 175 u32 orig_flags; 176 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 177 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 178 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 179 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 180}; 181 182/** 183 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 184 * 185 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 186 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 187 * different bands/PHY modes. 188 * 189 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 190 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 191 * with CCK rates. 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 193 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 194 * core code when registering the wiphy. 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 196 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 197 * core code when registering the wiphy. 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 199 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 200 * core code when registering the wiphy. 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 202 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 204 */ 205enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 206 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 207 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 208 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 209 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 213}; 214 215/** 216 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 217 * 218 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 219 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 220 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 223 */ 224enum ieee80211_bss_type { 225 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 226 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 227 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 230}; 231 232/** 233 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 234 * 235 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 236 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 237 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 238 */ 239enum ieee80211_privacy { 240 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 241 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 242 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 243}; 244 245#define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 246 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 247 248/** 249 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 250 * 251 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 252 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 253 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 254 * passed around. 255 * 256 * @flags: rate-specific flags 257 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 258 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 259 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 260 * short preamble is used 261 */ 262struct ieee80211_rate { 263 u32 flags; 264 u16 bitrate; 265 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 266}; 267 268/** 269 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 270 * 271 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 272 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 273 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 274 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 275 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 276 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 277 * members of the SRG 278 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 279 * used by members of the SRG 280 */ 281struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 282 bool enable; 283 u8 sr_ctrl; 284 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 285 u8 min_offset; 286 u8 max_offset; 287 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 288 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 289}; 290 291/** 292 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 293 * 294 * @color: the current color. 295 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 296 * @partial: define the AID equation. 297 */ 298struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 299 u8 color; 300 bool enabled; 301 bool partial; 302}; 303 304/** 305 * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 306 * 307 * @color: the current color. 308 * @disabled: is the feature disabled. 309 * @partial: define the AID equation. 310 */ 311struct ieee80211_he_bss_color { 312 u8 color; 313 bool disabled; 314 bool partial; 315}; 316 317/** 318 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 319 * 320 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 321 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 322 * 323 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 324 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 325 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 326 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 327 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 328 */ 329struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 330 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 331 bool ht_supported; 332 u8 ampdu_factor; 333 u8 ampdu_density; 334 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 335}; 336 337/** 338 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 339 * 340 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 341 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 342 * 343 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 344 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 345 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 346 */ 347struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 348 bool vht_supported; 349 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 350 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 351}; 352 353#define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 354 355/** 356 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 357 * 358 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 359 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 360 * 361 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 362 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 363 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 364 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 365 */ 366struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 367 bool has_he; 368 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 369 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 370 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 371}; 372 373/** 374 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data 375 * 376 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 377 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 378 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 379 * 380 * @types_mask: interface types mask 381 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 382 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 383 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 384 */ 385struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 386 u16 types_mask; 387 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 388 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 389}; 390 391/** 392 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 393 * 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 399 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 400 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 401 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 402 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 403 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 404 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 405 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 406 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 407 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 408 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 409 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 410 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 411 */ 412enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 414 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 415 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 416 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 417 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 418 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 419 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 420 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 421 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 422 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 423 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 424 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 425}; 426 427/** 428 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 429 * 430 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 431 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 432 * 433 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 434 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 435 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 436 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 437 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 438 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 439 */ 440struct ieee80211_edmg { 441 u8 channels; 442 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 443}; 444 445/** 446 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 447 * 448 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 449 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 450 * 451 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 452 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 453 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 454 */ 455struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 456 bool s1g; 457 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 458 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 459}; 460 461/** 462 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 463 * 464 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 465 * is able to operate in. 466 * 467 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 468 * in this band. 469 * @band: the band this structure represents 470 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 471 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 472 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 473 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 474 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 475 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 476 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 477 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 478 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 479 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 480 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 481 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 482 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 483 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 484 * iftype_data). 485 */ 486struct ieee80211_supported_band { 487 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 488 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 489 enum nl80211_band band; 490 int n_channels; 491 int n_bitrates; 492 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 493 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 494 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 495 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 496 u16 n_iftype_data; 497 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 498}; 499 500/** 501 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 502 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 503 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 504 * 505 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 506 */ 507static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 508ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 509 u8 iftype) 510{ 511 int i; 512 513 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 514 return NULL; 515 516 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) 517 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; 518 519 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 520 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 521 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 522 523 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 524 return data; 525 } 526 527 return NULL; 528} 529 530/** 531 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 532 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 533 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 534 * 535 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 536 */ 537static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 538ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 539 u8 iftype) 540{ 541 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 542 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 543 544 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 545 return &data->he_cap; 546 547 return NULL; 548} 549 550/** 551 * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA 552 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 553 * 554 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 555 */ 556static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 557ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband) 558{ 559 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION); 560} 561 562/** 563 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 564 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 565 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 566 * 567 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 568 */ 569static inline __le16 570ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 571 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 572{ 573 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 574 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 575 576 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 577 return 0; 578 579 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 580} 581 582/** 583 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 584 * 585 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 586 * 587 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 588 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 589 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 590 * 591 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 592 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 593 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 594 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 595 * without affecting other devices. 596 * 597 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 598 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 599 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 600 */ 601#ifdef CONFIG_OF 602void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 603#else /* CONFIG_OF */ 604static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 605{ 606} 607#endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 608 609 610/* 611 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 612 */ 613 614/** 615 * DOC: Actions and configuration 616 * 617 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 618 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 619 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 620 * operations use are described separately. 621 * 622 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 623 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 624 * 625 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 626 * in a separate chapter. 627 */ 628 629#define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 630 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 631 632/** 633 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 634 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 635 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 636 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 637 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 638 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 639 * determine the address as needed. 640 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 641 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 642 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 643 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 644 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 645 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 646 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 647 */ 648struct vif_params { 649 u32 flags; 650 int use_4addr; 651 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 652 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 653 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 654}; 655 656/** 657 * struct key_params - key information 658 * 659 * Information about a key 660 * 661 * @key: key material 662 * @key_len: length of key material 663 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 664 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 665 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 666 * length given by @seq_len. 667 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 668 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 669 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 670 */ 671struct key_params { 672 const u8 *key; 673 const u8 *seq; 674 int key_len; 675 int seq_len; 676 u16 vlan_id; 677 u32 cipher; 678 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 679}; 680 681/** 682 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 683 * @chan: the (control) channel 684 * @width: channel width 685 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 686 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 687 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 688 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 689 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 690 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 691 * parameters are ignored. 692 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 693 */ 694struct cfg80211_chan_def { 695 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 696 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 697 u32 center_freq1; 698 u32 center_freq2; 699 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 700 u16 freq1_offset; 701}; 702 703/* 704 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 705 */ 706struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 707 struct { 708 u32 legacy; 709 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 710 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 711 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 712 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 713 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 714 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 715 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 716}; 717 718 719/** 720 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 721 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 722 * of the peer. 723 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 724 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 725 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 726 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 727 * @retry_long: retry count value 728 * @retry_short: retry count value 729 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 730 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 731 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 732 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 733 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 734 */ 735struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 736 bool config_override; 737 u8 tids; 738 u64 mask; 739 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 740 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 741 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 742 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 743 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 744 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 745 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 746}; 747 748/** 749 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 750 * @peer: Station's MAC address 751 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 752 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 753 */ 754struct cfg80211_tid_config { 755 const u8 *peer; 756 u32 n_tid_conf; 757 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 758}; 759 760/** 761 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 762 * @chandef: the channel definition 763 * 764 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 765 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 766 */ 767static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 768cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 769{ 770 switch (chandef->width) { 771 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 772 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 773 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 774 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 775 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 776 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 777 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 778 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 779 default: 780 WARN_ON(1); 781 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 782 } 783} 784 785/** 786 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 787 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 788 * @channel: the control channel 789 * @chantype: the channel type 790 * 791 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 792 */ 793void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 794 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 795 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 796 797/** 798 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 799 * @chandef1: first channel definition 800 * @chandef2: second channel definition 801 * 802 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 803 * identical, %false otherwise. 804 */ 805static inline bool 806cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 807 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 808{ 809 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 810 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 811 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 812 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 813 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 814} 815 816/** 817 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 818 * 819 * @chandef: the channel definition 820 * 821 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 822 */ 823static inline bool 824cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 825{ 826 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 827} 828 829/** 830 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 831 * @chandef1: first channel definition 832 * @chandef2: second channel definition 833 * 834 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 835 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 836 */ 837const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 838cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 839 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 840 841/** 842 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 843 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 844 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 845 */ 846bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 847 848/** 849 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 850 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 851 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 852 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 853 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 854 */ 855bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 856 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 857 u32 prohibited_flags); 858 859/** 860 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 861 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 862 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 863 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 864 * Returns: 865 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 866 */ 867int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 868 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 869 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 870 871/** 872 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 873 * 874 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 875 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 876 * 877 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 878 * 879 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 880 */ 881static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 882ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 883{ 884 switch (chandef->width) { 885 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 886 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 887 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 888 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 889 default: 890 break; 891 } 892 return 0; 893} 894 895/** 896 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 897 * 898 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 899 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 900 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 901 * 902 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 903 * 904 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 905 */ 906static inline int 907ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 908{ 909 switch (chandef->width) { 910 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 911 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 912 chandef->chan->max_power); 913 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 914 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 915 chandef->chan->max_power); 916 default: 917 break; 918 } 919 return chandef->chan->max_power; 920} 921 922/** 923 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 924 * 925 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 926 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 927 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 928 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 929 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 930 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 931 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 932 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 933 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 934 * 935 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 936 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 937 */ 938enum survey_info_flags { 939 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 940 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 941 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 942 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 943 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 944 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 945 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 946 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 947 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 948}; 949 950/** 951 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 952 * 953 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 954 * record to report global statistics 955 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 956 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 957 * optional 958 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 959 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 960 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 961 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 962 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 963 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 964 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 965 * 966 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 967 * 968 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 969 * channel duty cycle etc. 970 */ 971struct survey_info { 972 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 973 u64 time; 974 u64 time_busy; 975 u64 time_ext_busy; 976 u64 time_rx; 977 u64 time_tx; 978 u64 time_scan; 979 u64 time_bss_rx; 980 u32 filled; 981 s8 noise; 982}; 983 984#define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 985 986/** 987 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 988 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 989 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 990 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 991 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 992 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 993 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 994 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 995 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 996 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 997 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 998 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 999 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 1000 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 1001 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 1002 * protocol frames. 1003 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1004 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1005 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 1006 * port for mac80211 1007 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 1008 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 1009 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 1010 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1011 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1012 * offload) 1013 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1014 */ 1015struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1016 u32 wpa_versions; 1017 u32 cipher_group; 1018 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1019 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1020 int n_akm_suites; 1021 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1022 bool control_port; 1023 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1024 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1025 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1026 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1027 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1028 int wep_tx_key; 1029 const u8 *psk; 1030 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1031 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1032}; 1033 1034/** 1035 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1036 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1037 * or %NULL if not changed 1038 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1039 * or %NULL if not changed 1040 * @head_len: length of @head 1041 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1042 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1043 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1044 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1045 * frames or %NULL 1046 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1047 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1048 * Response frames or %NULL 1049 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1050 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1051 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1052 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1053 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1054 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1055 * (measurement type 8) 1056 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1057 * Token (measurement type 11) 1058 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1059 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1060 */ 1061struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1062 const u8 *head, *tail; 1063 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1064 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1065 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1066 const u8 *probe_resp; 1067 const u8 *lci; 1068 const u8 *civicloc; 1069 s8 ftm_responder; 1070 1071 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1072 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1073 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1074 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1075 size_t probe_resp_len; 1076 size_t lci_len; 1077 size_t civicloc_len; 1078}; 1079 1080struct mac_address { 1081 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1082}; 1083 1084/** 1085 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1086 * 1087 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1088 * entry specified by mac_addr 1089 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1090 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1091 */ 1092struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1093 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1094 int n_acl_entries; 1095 1096 /* Keep it last */ 1097 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1098}; 1099 1100/** 1101 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1102 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1103 * 1104 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1105 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1106 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1107 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1108 * frame headers. 1109 */ 1110struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1111 u32 min_interval; 1112 u32 max_interval; 1113 size_t tmpl_len; 1114 const u8 *tmpl; 1115}; 1116 1117/** 1118 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1119 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1120 * 1121 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1122 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1123 * scanning 1124 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1125 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1126 */ 1127struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1128 u32 interval; 1129 size_t tmpl_len; 1130 const u8 *tmpl; 1131}; 1132 1133/** 1134 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1135 * 1136 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1137 * 1138 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1139 */ 1140enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1141 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1142}; 1143 1144/** 1145 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1146 * 1147 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1148 * 1149 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1150 * @beacon: beacon data 1151 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1152 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1153 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1154 * user space) 1155 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1156 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1157 * @crypto: crypto settings 1158 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1159 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1160 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1161 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1162 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1163 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1164 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1165 * MAC address based access control 1166 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1167 * networks. 1168 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1169 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1170 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1171 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1172 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1173 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1174 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1175 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1176 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1177 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1178 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1179 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1180 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1181 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1182 */ 1183struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1184 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1185 1186 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1187 1188 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1189 const u8 *ssid; 1190 size_t ssid_len; 1191 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1192 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1193 bool privacy; 1194 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1195 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1196 int inactivity_timeout; 1197 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1198 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1199 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1200 bool pbss; 1201 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1202 1203 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1204 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1205 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1206 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1207 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required; 1208 bool twt_responder; 1209 u32 flags; 1210 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1211 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1212 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1213 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1214}; 1215 1216/** 1217 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1218 * 1219 * Used for channel switch 1220 * 1221 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1222 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1223 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1224 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1225 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1226 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1227 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1228 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1229 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1230 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1231 */ 1232struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1233 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1234 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1235 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1236 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1237 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1238 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1239 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1240 bool radar_required; 1241 bool block_tx; 1242 u8 count; 1243}; 1244 1245#define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10 1246 1247/** 1248 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1249 * 1250 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1251 * 1252 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1253 * to use for verification 1254 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1255 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1256 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1257 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1258 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1259 * nl80211_iftype. 1260 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1261 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1262 * the verification 1263 */ 1264struct iface_combination_params { 1265 int num_different_channels; 1266 u8 radar_detect; 1267 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1268 u32 new_beacon_int; 1269}; 1270 1271/** 1272 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1273 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1274 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1275 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1276 * 1277 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1278 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1279 */ 1280enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1281 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1282 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1283 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1284 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1285}; 1286 1287/** 1288 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1289 * 1290 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1291 * 1292 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1293 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1294 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1295 * power per-interface or per-station. 1296 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1297 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1298 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1299 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1300 * per peer TPC. 1301 */ 1302struct sta_txpwr { 1303 s16 power; 1304 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1305}; 1306 1307/** 1308 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1309 * 1310 * Used to change and create a new station. 1311 * 1312 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1313 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1314 * (or NULL for no change) 1315 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1316 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1317 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1318 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1319 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1320 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1321 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1322 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1323 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1324 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1325 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1326 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1327 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1328 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1329 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1330 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1331 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1332 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1333 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1334 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1335 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1336 * to unknown) 1337 * @capability: station capability 1338 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1339 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1340 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1341 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1342 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1343 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1344 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1345 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1346 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1347 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1348 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1349 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1350 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1351 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1352 */ 1353struct station_parameters { 1354 const u8 *supported_rates; 1355 struct net_device *vlan; 1356 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1357 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1358 int listen_interval; 1359 u16 aid; 1360 u16 vlan_id; 1361 u16 peer_aid; 1362 u8 supported_rates_len; 1363 u8 plink_action; 1364 u8 plink_state; 1365 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1366 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1367 u8 uapsd_queues; 1368 u8 max_sp; 1369 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1370 u16 capability; 1371 const u8 *ext_capab; 1372 u8 ext_capab_len; 1373 const u8 *supported_channels; 1374 u8 supported_channels_len; 1375 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1376 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1377 u8 opmode_notif; 1378 bool opmode_notif_used; 1379 int support_p2p_ps; 1380 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1381 u8 he_capa_len; 1382 u16 airtime_weight; 1383 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1384 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1385}; 1386 1387/** 1388 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1389 * 1390 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1391 * 1392 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1393 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1394 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1395 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1396 */ 1397struct station_del_parameters { 1398 const u8 *mac; 1399 u8 subtype; 1400 u16 reason_code; 1401}; 1402 1403/** 1404 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1405 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1406 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1407 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1408 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1409 * the AP MLME in the device 1410 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1411 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1412 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1413 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1414 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1415 * supported/used) 1416 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1417 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1418 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1419 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1420 */ 1421enum cfg80211_station_type { 1422 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1423 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1424 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1425 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1426 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1427 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1428 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1429 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1430 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1431}; 1432 1433/** 1434 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1435 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1436 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1437 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1438 * 1439 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1440 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1441 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1442 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1443 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1444 */ 1445int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1446 struct station_parameters *params, 1447 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1448 1449/** 1450 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1451 * 1452 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1453 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1454 * 1455 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1456 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1457 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1458 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1459 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1460 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1461 */ 1462enum rate_info_flags { 1463 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1464 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1465 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1466 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1467 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1468 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1469}; 1470 1471/** 1472 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1473 * 1474 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1475 * 1476 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1477 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1478 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1479 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1480 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1481 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1482 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1483 */ 1484enum rate_info_bw { 1485 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1486 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1487 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1488 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1489 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1490 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1491 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1492}; 1493 1494/** 1495 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1496 * 1497 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1498 * 1499 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1500 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1501 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1502 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1503 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1504 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1505 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1506 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1507 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1508 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1509 */ 1510struct rate_info { 1511 u8 flags; 1512 u8 mcs; 1513 u16 legacy; 1514 u8 nss; 1515 u8 bw; 1516 u8 he_gi; 1517 u8 he_dcm; 1518 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1519 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1520}; 1521 1522/** 1523 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1524 * 1525 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1526 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1527 * 1528 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1529 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1530 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1531 */ 1532enum bss_param_flags { 1533 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1534 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1535 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1536}; 1537 1538/** 1539 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1540 * 1541 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1542 * 1543 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1544 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1545 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1546 */ 1547struct sta_bss_parameters { 1548 u8 flags; 1549 u8 dtim_period; 1550 u16 beacon_interval; 1551}; 1552 1553/** 1554 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1555 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1556 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1557 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1558 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1559 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1560 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1561 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1562 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1563 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1564 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1565 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1566 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1567 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1568 */ 1569struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1570 u32 filled; 1571 u32 backlog_bytes; 1572 u32 backlog_packets; 1573 u32 flows; 1574 u32 drops; 1575 u32 ecn_marks; 1576 u32 overlimit; 1577 u32 overmemory; 1578 u32 collisions; 1579 u32 tx_bytes; 1580 u32 tx_packets; 1581 u32 max_flows; 1582}; 1583 1584/** 1585 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1586 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1587 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1588 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1589 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1590 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1591 * transmitted MSDUs 1592 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1593 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1594 */ 1595struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1596 u32 filled; 1597 u64 rx_msdu; 1598 u64 tx_msdu; 1599 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1600 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1601 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1602}; 1603 1604#define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1605 1606/** 1607 * struct station_info - station information 1608 * 1609 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1610 * 1611 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1612 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1613 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1614 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1615 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1616 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1617 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1618 * @llid: mesh local link id 1619 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1620 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1621 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1622 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1623 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1624 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1625 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1626 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1627 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1628 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1629 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1630 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1631 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1632 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1633 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1634 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1635 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1636 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1637 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1638 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1639 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1640 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1641 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1642 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1643 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1644 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1645 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1646 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1647 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1648 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1649 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1650 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1651 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1652 * towards this station. 1653 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1654 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1655 * from this peer 1656 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1657 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1658 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1659 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1660 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1661 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1662 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1663 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1664 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1665 * been sent. 1666 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1667 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1668 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1669 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1670 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1671 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1672 */ 1673struct station_info { 1674 u64 filled; 1675 u32 connected_time; 1676 u32 inactive_time; 1677 u64 assoc_at; 1678 u64 rx_bytes; 1679 u64 tx_bytes; 1680 u16 llid; 1681 u16 plid; 1682 u8 plink_state; 1683 s8 signal; 1684 s8 signal_avg; 1685 1686 u8 chains; 1687 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1688 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1689 1690 struct rate_info txrate; 1691 struct rate_info rxrate; 1692 u32 rx_packets; 1693 u32 tx_packets; 1694 u32 tx_retries; 1695 u32 tx_failed; 1696 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1697 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1698 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1699 1700 int generation; 1701 1702 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1703 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1704 1705 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1706 s64 t_offset; 1707 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1708 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1709 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1710 1711 u32 expected_throughput; 1712 1713 u64 tx_duration; 1714 u64 rx_duration; 1715 u64 rx_beacon; 1716 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1717 u8 connected_to_gate; 1718 1719 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1720 s8 ack_signal; 1721 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1722 1723 u16 airtime_weight; 1724 1725 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1726 u32 fcs_err_count; 1727 1728 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1729 1730 u8 connected_to_as; 1731}; 1732 1733#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1734/** 1735 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1736 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1737 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1738 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1739 * 1740 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1741 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1742 * considered undefined. 1743 */ 1744int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1745 struct station_info *sinfo); 1746#else 1747static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1748 const u8 *mac_addr, 1749 struct station_info *sinfo) 1750{ 1751 return -ENOENT; 1752} 1753#endif 1754 1755/** 1756 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1757 * 1758 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1759 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1760 * 1761 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1762 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1763 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1764 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1765 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1766 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1767 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1768 */ 1769enum monitor_flags { 1770 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1771 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1772 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1773 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1774 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1775 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1776 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1777}; 1778 1779/** 1780 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1781 * 1782 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1783 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1784 * 1785 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1786 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1787 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1788 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1789 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1790 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1791 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1792 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1793 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1794 */ 1795enum mpath_info_flags { 1796 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1797 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1798 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1799 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1800 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1801 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1802 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1803 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1804 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1805}; 1806 1807/** 1808 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1809 * 1810 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1811 * 1812 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1813 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1814 * @sn: target sequence number 1815 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1816 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1817 * @flags: mesh path flags 1818 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1819 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1820 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1821 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1822 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1823 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1824 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1825 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1826 */ 1827struct mpath_info { 1828 u32 filled; 1829 u32 frame_qlen; 1830 u32 sn; 1831 u32 metric; 1832 u32 exptime; 1833 u32 discovery_timeout; 1834 u8 discovery_retries; 1835 u8 flags; 1836 u8 hop_count; 1837 u32 path_change_count; 1838 1839 int generation; 1840}; 1841 1842/** 1843 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1844 * 1845 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1846 * 1847 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1848 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1849 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1850 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1851 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1852 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1853 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1854 * (or NULL for no change) 1855 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1856 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1857 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1858 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1859 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1860 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1861 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1862 */ 1863struct bss_parameters { 1864 int use_cts_prot; 1865 int use_short_preamble; 1866 int use_short_slot_time; 1867 const u8 *basic_rates; 1868 u8 basic_rates_len; 1869 int ap_isolate; 1870 int ht_opmode; 1871 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1872}; 1873 1874/** 1875 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1876 * 1877 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1878 * 1879 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1880 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1881 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1882 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1883 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1884 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1885 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1886 * mesh interface 1887 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1888 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1889 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1890 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1891 * elements 1892 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1893 * detect compatible mesh peers 1894 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1895 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1896 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1897 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1898 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1899 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1900 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1901 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1902 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1903 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1904 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1905 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1906 * element 1907 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1908 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1909 * element 1910 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1911 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1912 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1913 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1914 * announcements are transmitted 1915 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1916 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1917 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1918 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1919 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1920 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 1921 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 1922 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 1923 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 1924 * station to establish a peer link 1925 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 1926 * 1927 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1928 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 1929 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 1930 * 1931 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 1932 * PREQs are transmitted. 1933 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 1934 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 1935 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 1936 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 1937 * setting for new peer links. 1938 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 1939 * after transmitting its beacon. 1940 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 1941 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 1942 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 1943 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 1944 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 1945 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 1946 * in the mesh path table 1947 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 1948 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 1949 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 1950 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 1951 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 1952 */ 1953struct mesh_config { 1954 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 1955 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 1956 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 1957 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 1958 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 1959 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 1960 u8 element_ttl; 1961 bool auto_open_plinks; 1962 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 1963 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 1964 u32 path_refresh_time; 1965 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 1966 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 1967 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 1968 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 1969 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 1970 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 1971 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 1972 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 1973 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 1974 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 1975 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 1976 s32 rssi_threshold; 1977 u16 ht_opmode; 1978 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 1979 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 1980 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 1981 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 1982 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 1983 u32 plink_timeout; 1984 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 1985}; 1986 1987/** 1988 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 1989 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1990 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 1991 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 1992 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 1993 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 1994 * @path_metric: which metric to use 1995 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 1996 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 1997 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 1998 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 1999 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2000 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2001 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2002 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2003 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2004 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2005 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2006 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2007 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2008 * to operate on DFS channels. 2009 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2010 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2011 * 2012 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2013 */ 2014struct mesh_setup { 2015 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2016 const u8 *mesh_id; 2017 u8 mesh_id_len; 2018 u8 sync_method; 2019 u8 path_sel_proto; 2020 u8 path_metric; 2021 u8 auth_id; 2022 const u8 *ie; 2023 u8 ie_len; 2024 bool is_authenticated; 2025 bool is_secure; 2026 bool user_mpm; 2027 u8 dtim_period; 2028 u16 beacon_interval; 2029 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2030 u32 basic_rates; 2031 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2032 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2033 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2034}; 2035 2036/** 2037 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2038 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2039 * 2040 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2041 */ 2042struct ocb_setup { 2043 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2044}; 2045 2046/** 2047 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2048 * @ac: AC identifier 2049 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2050 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2051 * 1..32767] 2052 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2053 * 1..32767] 2054 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2055 */ 2056struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2057 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2058 u16 txop; 2059 u16 cwmin; 2060 u16 cwmax; 2061 u8 aifs; 2062}; 2063 2064/** 2065 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2066 * 2067 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2068 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2069 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2070 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2071 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2072 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2073 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2074 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2075 * in the wiphy structure. 2076 * 2077 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2078 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2079 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2080 * 2081 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2082 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2083 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2084 * to userspace. 2085 */ 2086 2087/** 2088 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2089 * @ssid: the SSID 2090 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2091 */ 2092struct cfg80211_ssid { 2093 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2094 u8 ssid_len; 2095}; 2096 2097/** 2098 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2099 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2100 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2101 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2102 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2103 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2104 * userspace will be notified of that 2105 */ 2106struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2107 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2108 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2109 bool aborted; 2110}; 2111 2112/** 2113 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2114 * 2115 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for 2116 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2117 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2118 * which the above info relvant to 2119 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2120 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used 2121 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2122 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2123 */ 2124struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2125 u32 short_ssid; 2126 u32 channel_idx; 2127 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2128 bool unsolicited_probe; 2129 bool short_ssid_valid; 2130 bool psc_no_listen; 2131}; 2132 2133/** 2134 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2135 * 2136 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2137 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2138 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2139 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2140 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2141 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2142 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2143 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2144 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2145 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2146 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2147 * %duration field. 2148 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2149 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2150 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2151 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2152 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2153 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2154 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2155 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2156 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2157 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2158 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2159 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2160 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2161 * true if this is the second scan request 2162 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2163 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2164 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2165 */ 2166struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2167 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2168 int n_ssids; 2169 u32 n_channels; 2170 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2171 const u8 *ie; 2172 size_t ie_len; 2173 u16 duration; 2174 bool duration_mandatory; 2175 u32 flags; 2176 2177 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2178 2179 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2180 2181 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2182 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2183 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2184 2185 /* internal */ 2186 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2187 unsigned long scan_start; 2188 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2189 bool notified; 2190 bool no_cck; 2191 bool scan_6ghz; 2192 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2193 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2194 2195 /* keep last */ 2196 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2197}; 2198 2199static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2200{ 2201 int i; 2202 2203 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2204 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2205 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2206 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2207 } 2208} 2209 2210/** 2211 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2212 * 2213 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2214 * or no match (RSSI only) 2215 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2216 * or no match (RSSI only) 2217 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2218 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2219 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2220 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2221 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2222 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2223 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2224 * corresponding matchset. 2225 */ 2226struct cfg80211_match_set { 2227 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2228 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2229 s32 rssi_thold; 2230 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2231}; 2232 2233/** 2234 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2235 * 2236 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2237 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2238 * infinite loop. 2239 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2240 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2241 */ 2242struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2243 u32 interval; 2244 u32 iterations; 2245}; 2246 2247/** 2248 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2249 * 2250 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2251 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2252 */ 2253struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2254 enum nl80211_band band; 2255 s8 delta; 2256}; 2257 2258/** 2259 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2260 * 2261 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2262 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2263 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2264 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2265 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2266 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2267 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2268 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2269 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2270 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2271 * (others are filtered out). 2272 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2273 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2274 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2275 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2276 * @dev: the interface 2277 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2278 * @channels: channels to scan 2279 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2280 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2281 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2282 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2283 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2284 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2285 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2286 * index must be executed first. 2287 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2288 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2289 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2290 * owned by a particular socket) 2291 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2292 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2293 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2294 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2295 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2296 * supported. 2297 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2298 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2299 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2300 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2301 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2302 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2303 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2304 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2305 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2306 * comparisions. 2307 */ 2308struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2309 u64 reqid; 2310 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2311 int n_ssids; 2312 u32 n_channels; 2313 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2314 const u8 *ie; 2315 size_t ie_len; 2316 u32 flags; 2317 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2318 int n_match_sets; 2319 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2320 u32 delay; 2321 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2322 int n_scan_plans; 2323 2324 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2325 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2326 2327 bool relative_rssi_set; 2328 s8 relative_rssi; 2329 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2330 2331 /* internal */ 2332 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2333 struct net_device *dev; 2334 unsigned long scan_start; 2335 bool report_results; 2336 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2337 u32 owner_nlportid; 2338 bool nl_owner_dead; 2339 struct list_head list; 2340 2341 /* keep last */ 2342 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2343}; 2344 2345/** 2346 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2347 * 2348 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2349 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2350 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2351 */ 2352enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2353 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2354 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2355 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2356}; 2357 2358/** 2359 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2360 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2361 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2362 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2363 * signal type 2364 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2365 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2366 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2367 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2368 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2369 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2370 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2371 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2372 * by %parent_bssid. 2373 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2374 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2375 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2376 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2377 */ 2378struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2379 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2380 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2381 s32 signal; 2382 u64 boottime_ns; 2383 u64 parent_tsf; 2384 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2385 u8 chains; 2386 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2387}; 2388 2389/** 2390 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2391 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2392 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2393 * @len: length of the IEs 2394 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2395 * @data: IE data 2396 */ 2397struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2398 u64 tsf; 2399 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2400 int len; 2401 bool from_beacon; 2402 u8 data[]; 2403}; 2404 2405/** 2406 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2407 * 2408 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2409 * for use in scan results and similar. 2410 * 2411 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2412 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2413 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2414 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2415 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2416 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2417 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2418 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2419 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2420 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2421 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2422 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2423 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2424 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2425 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2426 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2427 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2428 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2429 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2430 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2431 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2432 * (multi-BSSID support) 2433 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2434 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2435 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2436 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2437 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2438 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2439 */ 2440struct cfg80211_bss { 2441 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2442 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2443 2444 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2445 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2446 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2447 2448 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2449 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2450 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2451 2452 s32 signal; 2453 2454 u16 beacon_interval; 2455 u16 capability; 2456 2457 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2458 u8 chains; 2459 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2460 2461 u8 bssid_index; 2462 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2463 2464 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2465}; 2466 2467/** 2468 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2469 * @bss: the bss to search 2470 * @id: the element ID 2471 * 2472 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2473 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2474 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2475 */ 2476const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2477 2478/** 2479 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2480 * @bss: the bss to search 2481 * @id: the element ID 2482 * 2483 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2484 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2485 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2486 */ 2487static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2488{ 2489 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2490} 2491 2492 2493/** 2494 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2495 * 2496 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2497 * authentication. 2498 * 2499 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2500 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2501 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2502 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2503 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2504 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2505 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2506 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2507 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2508 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2509 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2510 * transaction sequence number field. 2511 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2512 */ 2513struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2514 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2515 const u8 *ie; 2516 size_t ie_len; 2517 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2518 const u8 *key; 2519 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2520 const u8 *auth_data; 2521 size_t auth_data_len; 2522}; 2523 2524/** 2525 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2526 * 2527 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2528 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2529 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2530 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2531 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2532 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2533 * request (connect callback). 2534 */ 2535enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2536 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2537 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2538 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2539 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2540}; 2541 2542/** 2543 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2544 * 2545 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2546 * (re)association. 2547 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2548 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2549 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2550 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2551 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2552 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2553 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2554 * @crypto: crypto settings 2555 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2556 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2557 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2558 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2559 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2560 * frame. 2561 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2562 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2563 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2564 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2565 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2566 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2567 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2568 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2569 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2570 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2571 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2572 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2573 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 2574 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 2575 */ 2576struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2577 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2578 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2579 size_t ie_len; 2580 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2581 bool use_mfp; 2582 u32 flags; 2583 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2584 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2585 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2586 const u8 *fils_kek; 2587 size_t fils_kek_len; 2588 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2589 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 2590}; 2591 2592/** 2593 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2594 * 2595 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2596 * deauthentication. 2597 * 2598 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2599 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2600 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2601 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2602 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2603 * do not set a deauth frame 2604 */ 2605struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2606 const u8 *bssid; 2607 const u8 *ie; 2608 size_t ie_len; 2609 u16 reason_code; 2610 bool local_state_change; 2611}; 2612 2613/** 2614 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2615 * 2616 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2617 * disassociation. 2618 * 2619 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2620 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2621 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2622 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2623 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2624 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2625 */ 2626struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2627 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2628 const u8 *ie; 2629 size_t ie_len; 2630 u16 reason_code; 2631 bool local_state_change; 2632}; 2633 2634/** 2635 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2636 * 2637 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2638 * method. 2639 * 2640 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2641 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2642 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2643 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2644 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2645 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2646 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2647 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2648 * @ie_len: length of that 2649 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2650 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2651 * after joining 2652 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2653 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2654 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2655 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2656 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2657 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2658 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2659 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2660 * to operate on DFS channels. 2661 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2662 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2663 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2664 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2665 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2666 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2667 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2668 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2669 */ 2670struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2671 const u8 *ssid; 2672 const u8 *bssid; 2673 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2674 const u8 *ie; 2675 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2676 u16 beacon_interval; 2677 u32 basic_rates; 2678 bool channel_fixed; 2679 bool privacy; 2680 bool control_port; 2681 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2682 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2683 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2684 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2685 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2686 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2687 int wep_tx_key; 2688}; 2689 2690/** 2691 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2692 * 2693 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2694 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2695 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2696 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2697 */ 2698struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2699 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2700 union { 2701 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2702 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2703 } param; 2704}; 2705 2706/** 2707 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2708 * 2709 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2710 * authentication and association. 2711 * 2712 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2713 * on scan results) 2714 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2715 * %NULL if not specified 2716 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2717 * results) 2718 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2719 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2720 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2721 * to use. 2722 * @ssid: SSID 2723 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2724 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2725 * @ie: IEs for association request 2726 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2727 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2728 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2729 * @crypto: crypto settings 2730 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2731 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2732 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2733 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2734 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2735 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2736 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2737 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2738 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2739 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2740 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2741 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2742 * networks. 2743 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2744 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2745 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2746 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2747 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2748 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2749 * frame. 2750 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2751 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2752 * data IE. 2753 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2754 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2755 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2756 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2757 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2758 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2759 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2760 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2761 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2762 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2763 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2764 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2765 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2766 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2767 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2768 */ 2769struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2770 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2771 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2772 const u8 *bssid; 2773 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2774 const u8 *ssid; 2775 size_t ssid_len; 2776 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2777 const u8 *ie; 2778 size_t ie_len; 2779 bool privacy; 2780 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2781 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2782 const u8 *key; 2783 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2784 u32 flags; 2785 int bg_scan_period; 2786 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2787 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2788 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2789 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2790 bool pbss; 2791 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2792 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2793 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2794 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2795 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2796 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2797 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2798 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2799 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2800 bool want_1x; 2801 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2802}; 2803 2804/** 2805 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2806 * 2807 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2808 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2809 * 2810 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2811 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2812 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2813 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2814 */ 2815enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2816 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2817 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2818 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2819}; 2820 2821/** 2822 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2823 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2824 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2825 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2826 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2827 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2828 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2829 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2830 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2831 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2832 */ 2833enum wiphy_params_flags { 2834 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2835 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2836 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2837 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2838 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2839 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2840 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2841 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2842 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2843}; 2844 2845#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2846 2847/* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2848#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2849#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2850 2851/* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2852#define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2853 2854/** 2855 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2856 * 2857 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2858 * caching. 2859 * 2860 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2861 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2862 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2863 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2864 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2865 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2866 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2867 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2868 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2869 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2870 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2871 * %NULL). 2872 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2873 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2874 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2875 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2876 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2877 * used for it expires. 2878 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2879 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2880 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2881 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2882 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2883 */ 2884struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2885 const u8 *bssid; 2886 const u8 *pmkid; 2887 const u8 *pmk; 2888 size_t pmk_len; 2889 const u8 *ssid; 2890 size_t ssid_len; 2891 const u8 *cache_id; 2892 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2893 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2894}; 2895 2896/** 2897 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2898 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2899 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2900 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2901 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2902 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2903 * 2904 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2905 * memory, free @mask only! 2906 */ 2907struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2908 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2909 int pattern_len; 2910 int pkt_offset; 2911}; 2912 2913/** 2914 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2915 * 2916 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2917 * @src: source IP address 2918 * @dst: destination IP address 2919 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 2920 * @src_port: source port 2921 * @dst_port: destination port 2922 * @payload_len: data payload length 2923 * @payload: data payload buffer 2924 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 2925 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 2926 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 2927 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 2928 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 2929 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 2930 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 2931 */ 2932struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 2933 struct socket *sock; 2934 __be32 src, dst; 2935 u16 src_port, dst_port; 2936 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 2937 int payload_len; 2938 const u8 *payload; 2939 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 2940 u32 data_interval; 2941 u32 wake_len; 2942 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 2943 u32 tokens_size; 2944 /* must be last, variable member */ 2945 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 2946}; 2947 2948/** 2949 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 2950 * 2951 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 2952 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 2953 * operating as normal during suspend 2954 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 2955 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 2956 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 2957 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2958 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 2959 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 2960 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 2961 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 2962 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 2963 * NULL if not configured. 2964 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 2965 */ 2966struct cfg80211_wowlan { 2967 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 2968 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 2969 rfkill_release; 2970 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2971 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 2972 int n_patterns; 2973 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 2974}; 2975 2976/** 2977 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 2978 * 2979 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 2980 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 2981 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 2982 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 2983 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 2984 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2985 */ 2986struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 2987 int delay; 2988 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 2989 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2990 int n_patterns; 2991}; 2992 2993/** 2994 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 2995 * 2996 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 2997 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 2998 * @n_rules: number of rules 2999 */ 3000struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3001 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3002 int n_rules; 3003}; 3004 3005/** 3006 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3007 * 3008 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3009 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3010 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3011 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3012 * occurred (in MHz) 3013 */ 3014struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3015 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3016 int n_channels; 3017 u32 channels[]; 3018}; 3019 3020/** 3021 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3022 * 3023 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3024 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3025 * match information. 3026 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3027 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3028 */ 3029struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3030 int n_matches; 3031 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3032}; 3033 3034/** 3035 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3036 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3037 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3038 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3039 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3040 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3041 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3042 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3043 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3044 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3045 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3046 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3047 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3048 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3049 * it is. 3050 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3051 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3052 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3053 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3054 */ 3055struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3056 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3057 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3058 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3059 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3060 s32 pattern_idx; 3061 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3062 const void *packet; 3063 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3064}; 3065 3066/** 3067 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3068 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3069 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3070 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3071 * @kek_len: length of kek 3072 * @kck_len length of kck 3073 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3074 */ 3075struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3076 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3077 u32 akm; 3078 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3079}; 3080 3081/** 3082 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3083 * 3084 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3085 * 3086 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3087 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3088 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3089 */ 3090struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3091 u16 md; 3092 const u8 *ie; 3093 size_t ie_len; 3094}; 3095 3096/** 3097 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3098 * 3099 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3100 * 3101 * @chan: channel to use 3102 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3103 * @wait: duration for ROC 3104 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3105 * @len: buffer length 3106 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3107 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3108 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3109 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3110 */ 3111struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3112 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3113 bool offchan; 3114 unsigned int wait; 3115 const u8 *buf; 3116 size_t len; 3117 bool no_cck; 3118 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3119 int n_csa_offsets; 3120 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3121}; 3122 3123/** 3124 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3125 * 3126 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3127 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3128 */ 3129struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3130 u8 dscp; 3131 u8 up; 3132}; 3133 3134/** 3135 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3136 * 3137 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3138 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3139 */ 3140struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3141 u8 low; 3142 u8 high; 3143}; 3144 3145/* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3146#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3147#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3148#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3149 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3150 3151/** 3152 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3153 * 3154 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3155 * 3156 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3157 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3158 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3159 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3160 */ 3161struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3162 u8 num_des; 3163 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3164 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3165}; 3166 3167/** 3168 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3169 * 3170 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3171 * 3172 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3173 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3174 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3175 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3176 */ 3177struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3178 u8 master_pref; 3179 u8 bands; 3180}; 3181 3182/** 3183 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3184 * configuration 3185 * 3186 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3187 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3188 */ 3189enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3190 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3191 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3192}; 3193 3194/** 3195 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3196 * 3197 * @filter: the content of the filter 3198 * @len: the length of the filter 3199 */ 3200struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3201 const u8 *filter; 3202 u8 len; 3203}; 3204 3205/** 3206 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3207 * 3208 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3209 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3210 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3211 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3212 * implementation specific. 3213 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3214 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3215 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3216 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3217 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3218 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3219 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3220 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3221 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3222 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3223 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3224 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3225 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3226 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3227 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3228 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3229 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3230 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3231 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3232 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3233 */ 3234struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3235 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3236 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3237 u8 publish_type; 3238 bool close_range; 3239 bool publish_bcast; 3240 bool subscribe_active; 3241 u8 followup_id; 3242 u8 followup_reqid; 3243 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3244 u32 ttl; 3245 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3246 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3247 bool srf_include; 3248 const u8 *srf_bf; 3249 u8 srf_bf_len; 3250 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3251 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3252 int srf_num_macs; 3253 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3254 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3255 u8 num_tx_filters; 3256 u8 num_rx_filters; 3257 u8 instance_id; 3258 u64 cookie; 3259}; 3260 3261/** 3262 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3263 * 3264 * @aa: authenticator address 3265 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3266 * @pmk: the PMK material 3267 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3268 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3269 * holds PMK-R0. 3270 */ 3271struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3272 const u8 *aa; 3273 u8 pmk_len; 3274 const u8 *pmk; 3275 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3276}; 3277 3278/** 3279 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3280 * 3281 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3282 * 3283 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3284 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3285 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3286 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3287 * authentication response command interface. 3288 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3289 * authentication response command interface. 3290 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3291 * authentication request event interface. 3292 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3293 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3294 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3295 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3296 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3297 */ 3298struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3299 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3300 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3301 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3302 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3303 u16 status; 3304 const u8 *pmkid; 3305}; 3306 3307/** 3308 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3309 * 3310 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3311 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3312 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3313 * answered 3314 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3315 * successfully answered 3316 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3317 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3318 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3319 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3320 * of how much time the responder was busy 3321 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3322 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3323 * the responder 3324 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3325 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3326 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3327 */ 3328struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3329 u32 filled; 3330 u32 success_num; 3331 u32 partial_num; 3332 u32 failed_num; 3333 u32 asap_num; 3334 u32 non_asap_num; 3335 u64 total_duration_ms; 3336 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3337 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3338 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3339}; 3340 3341/** 3342 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3343 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3344 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3345 * reason than just "failure" 3346 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3347 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3348 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3349 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3350 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3351 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3352 * by the responder 3353 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3354 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3355 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3356 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3357 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3358 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3359 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3360 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3361 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3362 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3363 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3364 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3365 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3366 * the square root of the variance) 3367 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3368 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3369 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3370 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3371 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3372 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3373 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3374 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3375 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3376 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3377 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3378 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3379 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3380 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3381 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3382 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3383 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3384 */ 3385struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3386 const u8 *lci; 3387 const u8 *civicloc; 3388 unsigned int lci_len; 3389 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3390 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3391 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3392 s16 burst_index; 3393 u8 busy_retry_time; 3394 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3395 u8 burst_duration; 3396 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3397 s32 rssi_avg; 3398 s32 rssi_spread; 3399 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3400 s64 rtt_avg; 3401 s64 rtt_variance; 3402 s64 rtt_spread; 3403 s64 dist_avg; 3404 s64 dist_variance; 3405 s64 dist_spread; 3406 3407 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3408 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3409 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3410 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3411 tx_rate_valid:1, 3412 rx_rate_valid:1, 3413 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3414 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3415 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3416 dist_avg_valid:1, 3417 dist_variance_valid:1, 3418 dist_spread_valid:1; 3419}; 3420 3421/** 3422 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3423 * @addr: address of the peer 3424 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3425 * measurement was made) 3426 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3427 * @status: status of the measurement 3428 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3429 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3430 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3431 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3432 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3433 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3434 */ 3435struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3436 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3437 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3438 3439 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3440 3441 u8 final:1, 3442 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3443 3444 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3445 3446 union { 3447 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3448 }; 3449}; 3450 3451/** 3452 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3453 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3454 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3455 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3456 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3457 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3458 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3459 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3460 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3461 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3462 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3463 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3464 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3465 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3466 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3467 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3468 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3469 * 3470 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3471 */ 3472struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3473 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3474 u16 burst_period; 3475 u8 requested:1, 3476 asap:1, 3477 request_lci:1, 3478 request_civicloc:1, 3479 trigger_based:1, 3480 non_trigger_based:1; 3481 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3482 u8 burst_duration; 3483 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3484 u8 ftmr_retries; 3485}; 3486 3487/** 3488 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3489 * @addr: MAC address 3490 * @chandef: channel to use 3491 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3492 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3493 */ 3494struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3495 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3496 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3497 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3498 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3499}; 3500 3501/** 3502 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3503 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3504 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3505 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3506 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3507 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3508 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3509 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3510 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3511 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3512 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3513 * zero it means there's no timeout 3514 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3515 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3516 */ 3517struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3518 u64 cookie; 3519 void *drv_data; 3520 u32 n_peers; 3521 u32 nl_portid; 3522 3523 u32 timeout; 3524 3525 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3526 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3527 3528 struct list_head list; 3529 3530 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3531}; 3532 3533/** 3534 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3535 * 3536 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3537 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3538 * 3539 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3540 * 3541 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3542 * has to be done. 3543 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3544 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3545 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3546 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3547 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3548 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3549 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3550 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3551 */ 3552struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3553 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3554 u16 status; 3555 const u8 *ie; 3556 size_t ie_len; 3557}; 3558 3559/** 3560 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3561 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3562 * for the entire device 3563 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3564 * for the given interface 3565 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3566 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3567 * for these subtypes 3568 */ 3569struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3570 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3571 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3572}; 3573 3574/** 3575 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3576 * 3577 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3578 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3579 * 3580 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3581 * on success or a negative error code. 3582 * 3583 * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the 3584 * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this 3585 * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext. 3586 * 3587 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3588 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3589 * configured for the device. 3590 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3591 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3592 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3593 * the device. 3594 * 3595 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3596 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3597 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3598 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3599 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3600 * 3601 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3602 * 3603 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3604 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3605 * 3606 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3607 * when adding a group key. 3608 * 3609 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3610 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3611 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3612 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3613 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3614 * 3615 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3616 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3617 * 3618 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3619 * 3620 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3621 * 3622 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3623 * 3624 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3625 * 3626 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3627 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3628 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3629 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3630 * 3631 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3632 * @del_station: Remove a station 3633 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3634 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3635 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3636 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3637 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3638 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3639 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3640 * 3641 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3642 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3643 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3644 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3645 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3646 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3647 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3648 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3649 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3650 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3651 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3652 * 3653 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3654 * 3655 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3656 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3657 * set, and which to leave alone. 3658 * 3659 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3660 * 3661 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3662 * 3663 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3664 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3665 * join the mesh instead. 3666 * 3667 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3668 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3669 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3670 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3671 * 3672 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3673 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3674 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3675 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3676 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3677 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3678 * 3679 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3680 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3681 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3682 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3683 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3684 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3685 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3686 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3687 * 3688 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3689 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3690 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3691 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3692 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3693 * was received. 3694 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3695 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3696 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3697 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3698 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3699 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3700 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3701 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3702 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3703 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3704 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3705 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3706 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3707 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3708 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3709 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3710 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3711 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3712 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3713 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3714 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3715 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3716 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3717 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3718 * 3719 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3720 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3721 * to a merge. 3722 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3723 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3724 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3725 * 3726 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3727 * MESH mode) 3728 * 3729 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3730 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3731 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3732 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3733 * 3734 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3735 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3736 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3737 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3738 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3739 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3740 * return 0 if successful 3741 * 3742 * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface 3743 * 3744 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3745 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3746 * 3747 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3748 * 3749 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3750 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3751 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3752 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3753 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3754 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3755 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3756 * the duration value. 3757 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3758 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3759 * frame on another channel 3760 * 3761 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3762 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3763 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3764 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3765 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3766 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3767 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3768 * 3769 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3770 * 3771 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3772 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3773 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3774 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3775 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3776 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3777 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3778 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3779 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3780 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3781 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3782 * disabled.) 3783 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3784 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3785 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3786 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3787 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3788 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3789 * thresholds. 3790 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3791 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3792 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3793 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3794 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3795 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3796 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3797 * 3798 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3799 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3800 * 3801 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3802 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3803 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3804 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3805 * 3806 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3807 * 3808 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3809 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3810 * 3811 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3812 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3813 * 3814 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3815 * 3816 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3817 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3818 * current monitoring channel. 3819 * 3820 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3821 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3822 * 3823 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3824 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3825 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3826 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3827 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3828 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3829 * 3830 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3831 * 3832 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3833 * was finished on another phy. 3834 * 3835 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3836 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3837 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3838 * 3839 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3840 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3841 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3842 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3843 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3844 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3845 * 3846 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3847 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3848 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3849 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3850 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3851 * as soon as possible. 3852 * 3853 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3854 * 3855 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3856 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3857 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3858 * 3859 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3860 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3861 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3862 * account. 3863 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3864 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3865 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3866 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3867 * rejected) 3868 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3869 * 3870 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3871 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3872 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3873 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3874 * 3875 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3876 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3877 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3878 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3879 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3880 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3881 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3882 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3883 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3884 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3885 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3886 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3887 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3888 * provided @nan_func. 3889 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3890 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3891 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3892 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3893 * 3894 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3895 * 3896 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3897 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3898 * 3899 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3900 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3901 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3902 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3903 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3904 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3905 * 3906 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3907 * user space 3908 * 3909 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 3910 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 3911 * 3912 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 3913 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 3914 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 3915 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 3916 * 3917 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 3918 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 3919 * DH IE through this interface. 3920 * 3921 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 3922 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 3923 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 3924 * This callback may sleep. 3925 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 3926 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 3927 */ 3928struct cfg80211_ops { 3929 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 3930 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 3931 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 3932 3933 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3934 const char *name, 3935 unsigned char name_assign_type, 3936 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3937 struct vif_params *params); 3938 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3939 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 3940 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3941 struct net_device *dev, 3942 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3943 struct vif_params *params); 3944 3945 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3946 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3947 struct key_params *params); 3948 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3949 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3950 void *cookie, 3951 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 3952 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3953 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 3954 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3955 struct net_device *netdev, 3956 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 3957 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3958 struct net_device *netdev, 3959 u8 key_index); 3960 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3961 struct net_device *netdev, 3962 u8 key_index); 3963 3964 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3965 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 3966 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3967 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 3968 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 3969 3970 3971 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3972 const u8 *mac, 3973 struct station_parameters *params); 3974 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3975 struct station_del_parameters *params); 3976 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3977 const u8 *mac, 3978 struct station_parameters *params); 3979 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3980 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3981 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3982 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3983 3984 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3985 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3986 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3987 const u8 *dst); 3988 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3989 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3990 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3991 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3992 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3993 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 3994 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3995 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3996 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3997 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3998 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 3999 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4000 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4001 struct net_device *dev, 4002 struct mesh_config *conf); 4003 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4004 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4005 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4006 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4007 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4008 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4009 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4010 4011 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4012 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4013 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4014 4015 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4016 struct bss_parameters *params); 4017 4018 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4019 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4020 4021 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4022 struct net_device *dev, 4023 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4024 4025 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4026 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4027 4028 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4029 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4030 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4031 4032 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4033 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4034 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4035 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4036 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4037 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4038 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4039 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4040 4041 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4042 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4043 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4044 struct net_device *dev, 4045 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4046 u32 changed); 4047 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4048 u16 reason_code); 4049 4050 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4051 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4052 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4053 4054 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4055 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4056 4057 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4058 4059 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4060 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4061 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4062 int *dbm); 4063 4064 int (*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4065 const u8 *addr); 4066 4067 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4068 4069#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4070 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4071 void *data, int len); 4072 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4073 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4074 void *data, int len); 4075#endif 4076 4077 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4078 struct net_device *dev, 4079 const u8 *peer, 4080 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4081 4082 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4083 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4084 4085 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4086 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4087 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4088 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4089 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4090 4091 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4092 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4093 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4094 unsigned int duration, 4095 u64 *cookie); 4096 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4097 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4098 u64 cookie); 4099 4100 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4101 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4102 u64 *cookie); 4103 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4104 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4105 u64 cookie); 4106 4107 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4108 bool enabled, int timeout); 4109 4110 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4111 struct net_device *dev, 4112 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4113 4114 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4115 struct net_device *dev, 4116 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4117 4118 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4119 struct net_device *dev, 4120 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4121 4122 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4123 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4124 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4125 4126 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4127 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4128 4129 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4130 struct net_device *dev, 4131 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4132 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4133 u64 reqid); 4134 4135 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4136 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4137 4138 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4139 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4140 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4141 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4142 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4143 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4144 4145 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4146 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4147 4148 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4149 struct net_device *dev, 4150 u16 noack_map); 4151 4152 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4153 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4154 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4155 4156 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4157 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4158 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4159 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4160 4161 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4162 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4163 4164 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4165 struct net_device *dev, 4166 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4167 u32 cac_time_ms); 4168 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4169 struct net_device *dev); 4170 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4171 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4172 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4173 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4174 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4175 u16 duration); 4176 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4177 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4178 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4179 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4180 4181 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4182 struct net_device *dev, 4183 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4184 4185 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4186 struct net_device *dev, 4187 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4188 4189 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4190 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4191 4192 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4193 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4194 u16 admitted_time); 4195 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4196 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4197 4198 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4199 struct net_device *dev, 4200 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4201 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4202 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4203 struct net_device *dev, 4204 const u8 *addr); 4205 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4206 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4207 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4208 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4209 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4210 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4211 u64 cookie); 4212 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4213 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4214 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4215 u32 changes); 4216 4217 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4218 struct net_device *dev, 4219 const bool enabled); 4220 4221 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4222 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4223 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4224 4225 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4226 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4227 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4228 const u8 *aa); 4229 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4230 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4231 4232 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4233 struct net_device *dev, 4234 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4235 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4236 const bool noencrypt, 4237 u64 *cookie); 4238 4239 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4240 struct net_device *dev, 4241 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4242 4243 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4244 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4245 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4246 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4247 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4248 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4249 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4250 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4251 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4252 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4253 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4254 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4255}; 4256 4257/* 4258 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4259 * and registration/helper functions 4260 */ 4261 4262/** 4263 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4264 * 4265 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4266 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4267 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4268 * wiphy at all 4269 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4270 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4271 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4272 * reason to override the default 4273 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4274 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4275 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4276 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4277 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4278 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4279 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4280 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4281 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4282 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4283 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4284 * firmware. 4285 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4286 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4287 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4288 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4289 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4290 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4291 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4292 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4293 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4294 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4295 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4296 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4297 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4298 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4299 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4300 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4301 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4302 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4303 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4304 * before connection. 4305 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4306 */ 4307enum wiphy_flags { 4308 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4309 /* use hole at 1 */ 4310 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4311 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4312 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4313 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4314 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4315 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4316 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4317 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4318 /* use hole at 11 */ 4319 /* use hole at 12 */ 4320 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4321 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4322 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4323 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4324 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4325 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4326 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4327 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4328 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4329 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4330 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4331 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4332}; 4333 4334/** 4335 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4336 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4337 * @types: interface types (bits) 4338 */ 4339struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4340 u16 max; 4341 u16 types; 4342}; 4343 4344/** 4345 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4346 * 4347 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4348 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4349 * 4350 * Examples: 4351 * 4352 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4353 * 4354 * .. code-block:: c 4355 * 4356 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4357 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4358 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4359 * }; 4360 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4361 * .limits = limits1, 4362 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4363 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4364 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4365 * }; 4366 * 4367 * 4368 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4369 * 4370 * .. code-block:: c 4371 * 4372 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4373 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4374 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4375 * }; 4376 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4377 * .limits = limits2, 4378 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4379 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4380 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4381 * }; 4382 * 4383 * 4384 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4385 * 4386 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4387 * 4388 * .. code-block:: c 4389 * 4390 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4391 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4392 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4393 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4394 * }; 4395 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4396 * .limits = limits3, 4397 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4398 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4399 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4400 * }; 4401 * 4402 */ 4403struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4404 /** 4405 * @limits: 4406 * limits for the given interface types 4407 */ 4408 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4409 4410 /** 4411 * @num_different_channels: 4412 * can use up to this many different channels 4413 */ 4414 u32 num_different_channels; 4415 4416 /** 4417 * @max_interfaces: 4418 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4419 */ 4420 u16 max_interfaces; 4421 4422 /** 4423 * @n_limits: 4424 * number of limitations 4425 */ 4426 u8 n_limits; 4427 4428 /** 4429 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4430 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4431 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4432 */ 4433 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4434 4435 /** 4436 * @radar_detect_widths: 4437 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4438 */ 4439 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4440 4441 /** 4442 * @radar_detect_regions: 4443 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4444 */ 4445 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4446 4447 /** 4448 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4449 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4450 * 4451 * = 0 4452 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4453 * > 0 4454 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4455 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4456 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4457 */ 4458 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4459}; 4460 4461struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4462 u16 tx, rx; 4463}; 4464 4465/** 4466 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4467 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4468 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4469 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4470 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4471 * packet should be preserved in that case 4472 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4473 * (see nl80211.h) 4474 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4475 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4476 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4477 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4478 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4479 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4480 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4481 */ 4482enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4483 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4484 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4485 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4486 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4487 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4488 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4489 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4490 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4491 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4492}; 4493 4494struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4495 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4496 u32 data_payload_max; 4497 u32 data_interval_max; 4498 u32 wake_payload_max; 4499 bool seq; 4500}; 4501 4502/** 4503 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4504 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4505 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4506 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4507 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4508 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4509 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4510 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4511 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4512 * scheduled scans. 4513 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4514 * details. 4515 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4516 */ 4517struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4518 u32 flags; 4519 int n_patterns; 4520 int pattern_max_len; 4521 int pattern_min_len; 4522 int max_pkt_offset; 4523 int max_nd_match_sets; 4524 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4525}; 4526 4527/** 4528 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4529 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4530 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4531 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4532 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4533 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4534 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4535 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4536 */ 4537struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4538 int n_rules; 4539 int max_delay; 4540 int n_patterns; 4541 int pattern_max_len; 4542 int pattern_min_len; 4543 int max_pkt_offset; 4544}; 4545 4546/** 4547 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4548 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4549 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4550 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4551 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4552 */ 4553enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4554 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4555 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4556 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4557}; 4558 4559/** 4560 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4561 * 4562 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4563 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4564 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4565 * 4566 */ 4567enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4568 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4569 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4570 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4571}; 4572 4573/** 4574 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4575 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4576 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4577 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4578 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4579 */ 4580 4581struct sta_opmode_info { 4582 u32 changed; 4583 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4584 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4585 u8 rx_nss; 4586}; 4587 4588#define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4589 4590/** 4591 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4592 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4593 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4594 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4595 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4596 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4597 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4598 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4599 * dumpit calls. 4600 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4601 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4602 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4603 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4604 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4605 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4606 * are used with dump requests. 4607 */ 4608struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4609 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4610 u32 flags; 4611 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4612 const void *data, int data_len); 4613 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4614 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4615 unsigned long *storage); 4616 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4617 unsigned int maxattr; 4618}; 4619 4620/** 4621 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4622 * @iftype: interface type 4623 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4624 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4625 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4626 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4627 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4628 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4629 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4630 */ 4631struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4632 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4633 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4634 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4635 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4636}; 4637 4638/** 4639 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4640 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4641 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4642 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4643 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4644 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4645 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4646 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4647 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4648 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4649 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4650 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4651 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4652 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4653 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4654 * not limited) 4655 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4656 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4657 */ 4658struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4659 unsigned int max_peers; 4660 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4661 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4662 4663 struct { 4664 u32 preambles; 4665 u32 bandwidths; 4666 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4667 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4668 u8 supported:1, 4669 asap:1, 4670 non_asap:1, 4671 request_lci:1, 4672 request_civicloc:1, 4673 trigger_based:1, 4674 non_trigger_based:1; 4675 } ftm; 4676}; 4677 4678/** 4679 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4680 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4681 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4682 * 4683 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4684 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4685 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4686 */ 4687struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4688 u16 iftypes_mask; 4689 const u32 *akm_suites; 4690 int n_akm_suites; 4691}; 4692 4693/** 4694 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4695 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4696 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4697 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4698 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4699 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4700 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4701 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4702 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4703 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4704 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4705 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4706 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4707 * iftype_akm_suites. 4708 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4709 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4710 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4711 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4712 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4713 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4714 * suites are specified separately. 4715 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4716 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4717 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4718 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4719 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4720 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4721 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4722 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4723 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4724 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4725 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4726 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4727 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4728 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4729 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4730 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4731 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4732 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4733 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4734 * unregister hardware 4735 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4736 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4737 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4738 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4739 * (see below). 4740 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4741 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4742 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4743 * must be set by driver 4744 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4745 * list single interface types. 4746 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4747 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4748 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4749 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4750 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4751 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4752 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4753 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4754 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4755 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4756 * this variable determines its size 4757 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4758 * any given scan 4759 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4760 * the device can run concurrently. 4761 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4762 * for in any given scheduled scan 4763 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4764 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4765 * supported. 4766 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4767 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4768 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4769 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4770 * scans 4771 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4772 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4773 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4774 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4775 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4776 * scan plan supported by the device. 4777 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4778 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4779 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4780 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4781 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4782 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4783 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4784 * 4785 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4786 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4787 * type 4788 * 4789 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4790 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4791 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4792 * 4793 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4794 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4795 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4796 * 4797 * @probe_resp_offload: 4798 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4799 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4800 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4801 * 4802 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4803 * may request, if implemented. 4804 * 4805 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4806 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4807 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4808 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4809 * 4810 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4811 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4812 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4813 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4814 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4815 * 4816 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4817 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4818 * 4819 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4820 * supports for ACL. 4821 * 4822 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4823 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4824 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4825 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4826 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4827 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4828 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4829 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4830 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4831 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4832 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4833 * capabilities are specified separately. 4834 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4835 * 4836 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4837 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4838 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4839 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4840 * 4841 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4842 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4843 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4844 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4845 * 4846 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4847 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4848 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4849 * infinite. 4850 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4851 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4852 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4853 * 4854 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4855 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4856 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4857 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4858 * 4859 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4860 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4861 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4862 * 4863 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4864 * wake_tx_queue 4865 * 4866 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4867 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4868 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4869 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4870 * 4871 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4872 * 4873 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4874 * device has 4875 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4876 * supported by the driver for each vif 4877 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4878 * supported by the driver for each peer 4879 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4880 * long/short retry configuration 4881 * 4882 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4883 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4884 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4885 */ 4886struct wiphy { 4887 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4888 4889 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4890 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4891 4892 struct mac_address *addresses; 4893 4894 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4895 4896 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4897 int n_iface_combinations; 4898 u16 software_iftypes; 4899 4900 u16 n_addresses; 4901 4902 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 4903 u16 interface_modes; 4904 4905 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 4906 4907 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 4908 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 4909 4910 u32 ap_sme_capa; 4911 4912 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 4913 4914 int bss_priv_size; 4915 u8 max_scan_ssids; 4916 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 4917 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 4918 u8 max_match_sets; 4919 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 4920 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 4921 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 4922 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 4923 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 4924 4925 int n_cipher_suites; 4926 const u32 *cipher_suites; 4927 4928 int n_akm_suites; 4929 const u32 *akm_suites; 4930 4931 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 4932 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 4933 4934 u8 retry_short; 4935 u8 retry_long; 4936 u32 frag_threshold; 4937 u32 rts_threshold; 4938 u8 coverage_class; 4939 4940 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 4941 u32 hw_version; 4942 4943#ifdef CONFIG_PM 4944 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 4945 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 4946#endif 4947 4948 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 4949 4950 u8 max_num_pmkids; 4951 4952 u32 available_antennas_tx; 4953 u32 available_antennas_rx; 4954 4955 u32 probe_resp_offload; 4956 4957 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 4958 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4959 4960 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 4961 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 4962 4963 const void *privid; 4964 4965 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 4966 4967 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4968 struct regulatory_request *request); 4969 4970 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 4971 4972 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 4973 4974 struct device dev; 4975 4976 bool registered; 4977 4978 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 4979 4980 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 4981 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 4982 4983 struct list_head wdev_list; 4984 4985 possible_net_t _net; 4986 4987#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 4988 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 4989#endif 4990 4991 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 4992 4993 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 4994 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 4995 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 4996 4997 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 4998 4999 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5000 5001 u32 bss_select_support; 5002 5003 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5004 5005 u32 txq_limit; 5006 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5007 u32 txq_quantum; 5008 5009 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5010 5011 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5012 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5013 5014 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5015 5016 struct { 5017 u64 peer, vif; 5018 u8 max_retry; 5019 } tid_config_support; 5020 5021 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5022 5023 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5024}; 5025 5026static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5027{ 5028 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5029} 5030 5031static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5032{ 5033 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5034} 5035 5036/** 5037 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5038 * 5039 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5040 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5041 */ 5042static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5043{ 5044 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5045 return &wiphy->priv; 5046} 5047 5048/** 5049 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5050 * 5051 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5052 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5053 */ 5054static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5055{ 5056 BUG_ON(!priv); 5057 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5058} 5059 5060/** 5061 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5062 * 5063 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5064 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5065 */ 5066static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5067{ 5068 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5069} 5070 5071/** 5072 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5073 * 5074 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5075 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5076 */ 5077static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5078{ 5079 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5080} 5081 5082/** 5083 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5084 * 5085 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5086 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5087 */ 5088static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5089{ 5090 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5091} 5092 5093/** 5094 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5095 * 5096 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5097 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5098 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5099 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5100 * 5101 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5102 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5103 * 5104 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5105 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5106 */ 5107struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5108 const char *requested_name); 5109 5110/** 5111 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5112 * 5113 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5114 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5115 * 5116 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5117 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5118 * 5119 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5120 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5121 */ 5122static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5123 int sizeof_priv) 5124{ 5125 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5126} 5127 5128/** 5129 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5130 * 5131 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5132 * 5133 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5134 */ 5135int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5136 5137/** 5138 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5139 * 5140 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5141 * 5142 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5143 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5144 * request that is being handled. 5145 */ 5146void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5147 5148/** 5149 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5150 * 5151 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5152 */ 5153void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5154 5155/* internal structs */ 5156struct cfg80211_conn; 5157struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5158struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5159struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5160 5161/** 5162 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5163 * 5164 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5165 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5166 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5167 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5168 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device. 5169 * 5170 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5171 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5172 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5173 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5174 * 5175 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5176 * @iftype: interface type 5177 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5178 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5179 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5180 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5181 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5182 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5183 * the user-set channel definition. 5184 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5185 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5186 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5187 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5188 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5189 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5190 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5191 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5192 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5193 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5194 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5195 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5196 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5197 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5198 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5199 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5200 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5201 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5202 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5203 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5204 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5205 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5206 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5207 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5208 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5209 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5210 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5211 * and some API functions require it held 5212 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5213 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5214 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5215 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5216 * the P2P Device. 5217 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5218 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5219 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5220 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5221 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5222 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5223 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5224 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5225 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5226 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5227 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5228 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5229 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5230 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5231 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5232 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5233 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5234 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5235 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5236 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5237 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5238 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5239 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5240 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5241 * unprotected beacon report 5242 */ 5243struct wireless_dev { 5244 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5245 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5246 5247 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5248 struct list_head list; 5249 struct net_device *netdev; 5250 5251 u32 identifier; 5252 5253 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5254 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5255 5256 struct mutex mtx; 5257 5258 bool use_4addr, is_running; 5259 5260 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5261 5262 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5263 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5264 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5265 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5266 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5267 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5268 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5269 5270 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5271 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5272 5273 struct list_head event_list; 5274 spinlock_t event_lock; 5275 5276 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5277 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5278 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5279 5280 bool ibss_fixed; 5281 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5282 5283 bool ps; 5284 int ps_timeout; 5285 5286 int beacon_interval; 5287 5288 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5289 5290 u32 owner_nlportid; 5291 bool nl_owner_dead; 5292 5293 bool cac_started; 5294 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5295 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5296 5297#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5298 /* wext data */ 5299 struct { 5300 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5301 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5302 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5303 const u8 *ie; 5304 size_t ie_len; 5305 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5306 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5307 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5308 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5309 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5310 } wext; 5311#endif 5312 5313 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5314 5315 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5316 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5317 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5318 5319 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5320}; 5321 5322static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5323{ 5324 if (wdev->netdev) 5325 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5326 return wdev->address; 5327} 5328 5329static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5330{ 5331 if (wdev->netdev) 5332 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5333 return wdev->is_running; 5334} 5335 5336/** 5337 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5338 * 5339 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5340 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5341 */ 5342static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5343{ 5344 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5345 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5346} 5347 5348/** 5349 * DOC: Utility functions 5350 * 5351 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5352 */ 5353 5354/** 5355 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5356 * 5357 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5358 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5359 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5360 */ 5361static inline bool 5362ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5363 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5364{ 5365 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5366 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5367} 5368 5369/** 5370 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5371 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5372 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5373 */ 5374static inline u32 5375ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5376{ 5377 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5378} 5379 5380/** 5381 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5382 * 5383 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5384 * @chan: channel 5385 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5386 */ 5387enum nl80211_chan_width 5388ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5389 5390/** 5391 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5392 * @chan: channel number 5393 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5394 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5395 */ 5396u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5397 5398/** 5399 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5400 * @chan: channel number 5401 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5402 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5403 */ 5404static inline int 5405ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5406{ 5407 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5408} 5409 5410/** 5411 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5412 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5413 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5414 */ 5415int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5416 5417/** 5418 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5419 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5420 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5421 */ 5422static inline int 5423ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5424{ 5425 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5426} 5427 5428/** 5429 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5430 * frequency 5431 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5432 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5433 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5434 */ 5435struct ieee80211_channel * 5436ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5437 5438/** 5439 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5440 * 5441 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5442 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5443 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5444 */ 5445static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5446ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5447{ 5448 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5449} 5450 5451/** 5452 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5453 * @chan: control channel to check 5454 * 5455 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5456 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5457 */ 5458static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5459{ 5460 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5461 return false; 5462 5463 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5464} 5465 5466/** 5467 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5468 * 5469 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5470 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5471 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5472 * 5473 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5474 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5475 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5476 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5477 */ 5478struct ieee80211_rate * 5479ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5480 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5481 5482/** 5483 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5484 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5485 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5486 * 5487 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5488 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5489 */ 5490u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5491 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5492 5493/* 5494 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5495 * 5496 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5497 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5498 */ 5499 5500struct radiotap_align_size { 5501 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5502}; 5503 5504struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5505 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5506 int n_bits; 5507 uint32_t oui; 5508 uint8_t subns; 5509}; 5510 5511struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5512 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5513 int n_ns; 5514}; 5515 5516/** 5517 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5518 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5519 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5520 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5521 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5522 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5523 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5524 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5525 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5526 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5527 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5528 * radiotap namespace or not 5529 * 5530 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5531 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5532 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5533 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5534 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5535 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5536 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5537 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5538 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5539 * next bitmap word 5540 * 5541 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5542 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5543 */ 5544 5545struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5546 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5547 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5548 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5549 5550 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5551 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5552 5553 unsigned char *this_arg; 5554 int this_arg_index; 5555 int this_arg_size; 5556 5557 int is_radiotap_ns; 5558 5559 int _max_length; 5560 int _arg_index; 5561 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5562 int _reset_on_ext; 5563}; 5564 5565int 5566ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5567 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5568 int max_length, 5569 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5570 5571int 5572ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5573 5574 5575extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5576extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5577 5578/** 5579 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5580 * 5581 * @skb: the frame 5582 * 5583 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5584 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5585 * 5586 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5587 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5588 * 802.11 header. 5589 */ 5590unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5591 5592/** 5593 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5594 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5595 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5596 */ 5597unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5598 5599/** 5600 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5601 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5602 * (first byte) will be accessed 5603 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5604 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5605 */ 5606unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5607 5608/** 5609 * DOC: Data path helpers 5610 * 5611 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5612 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5613 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5614 */ 5615 5616/** 5617 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5618 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5619 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5620 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5621 * @addr: the device MAC address 5622 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5623 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5624 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5625 */ 5626int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5627 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5628 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 5629 5630/** 5631 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5632 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5633 * @addr: the device MAC address 5634 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5635 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5636 */ 5637static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5638 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5639{ 5640 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 5641} 5642 5643/** 5644 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5645 * 5646 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5647 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5648 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5649 * 5650 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5651 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5652 * initialized by the caller. 5653 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5654 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5655 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5656 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5657 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5658 */ 5659void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5660 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5661 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5662 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5663 5664/** 5665 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5666 * @skb: the data frame 5667 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5668 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5669 */ 5670unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5671 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5672 5673/** 5674 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5675 * 5676 * @eid: element ID 5677 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5678 * @len: length of data 5679 * @match: byte array to match 5680 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5681 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5682 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5683 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5684 * the data portion instead. 5685 * 5686 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5687 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5688 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5689 * requested element struct. 5690 * 5691 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5692 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5693 * byte array to match. 5694 */ 5695const struct element * 5696cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5697 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5698 unsigned int match_offset); 5699 5700/** 5701 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5702 * 5703 * @eid: element ID 5704 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5705 * @len: length of data 5706 * @match: byte array to match 5707 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5708 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5709 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5710 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5711 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5712 * the second byte is the IE length. 5713 * 5714 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5715 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5716 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5717 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5718 * element ID. 5719 * 5720 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5721 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5722 * byte array to match. 5723 */ 5724static inline const u8 * 5725cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5726 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5727 unsigned int match_offset) 5728{ 5729 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5730 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5731 */ 5732 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5733 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5734 return NULL; 5735 5736 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5737 match, match_len, 5738 match_offset ? 5739 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5740} 5741 5742/** 5743 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5744 * 5745 * @eid: element ID 5746 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5747 * @len: length of data 5748 * 5749 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5750 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5751 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5752 * requested element struct. 5753 * 5754 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5755 * having to fit into the given data. 5756 */ 5757static inline const struct element * 5758cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5759{ 5760 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5761} 5762 5763/** 5764 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5765 * 5766 * @eid: element ID 5767 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5768 * @len: length of data 5769 * 5770 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5771 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5772 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5773 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5774 * 5775 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5776 * having to fit into the given data. 5777 */ 5778static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5779{ 5780 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5781} 5782 5783/** 5784 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5785 * 5786 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5787 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5788 * @len: length of data 5789 * 5790 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5791 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5792 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5793 * requested element struct. 5794 * 5795 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5796 * having to fit into the given data. 5797 */ 5798static inline const struct element * 5799cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5800{ 5801 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5802 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5803} 5804 5805/** 5806 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5807 * 5808 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5809 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5810 * @len: length of data 5811 * 5812 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5813 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5814 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5815 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5816 * 5817 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5818 * having to fit into the given data. 5819 */ 5820static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5821{ 5822 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5823 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5824} 5825 5826/** 5827 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 5828 * 5829 * @oui: vendor OUI 5830 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5831 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5832 * @len: length of data 5833 * 5834 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5835 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 5836 * return the element structure for the requested element. 5837 * 5838 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5839 * the given data. 5840 */ 5841const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5842 const u8 *ies, 5843 unsigned int len); 5844 5845/** 5846 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 5847 * 5848 * @oui: vendor OUI 5849 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5850 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5851 * @len: length of data 5852 * 5853 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5854 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 5855 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5856 * element ID. 5857 * 5858 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5859 * the given data. 5860 */ 5861static inline const u8 * 5862cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5863 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 5864{ 5865 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 5866} 5867 5868/** 5869 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 5870 * 5871 * @dev: network device 5872 * @addr: STA MAC address 5873 * 5874 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 5875 * devices upon STA association. 5876 */ 5877void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 5878 5879/** 5880 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 5881 * 5882 * TODO 5883 */ 5884 5885/** 5886 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 5887 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 5888 * conflicts) 5889 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 5890 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 5891 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 5892 * alpha2. 5893 * 5894 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 5895 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 5896 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 5897 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 5898 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 5899 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 5900 * 5901 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 5902 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 5903 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 5904 * 5905 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 5906 * an -ENOMEM. 5907 * 5908 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 5909 */ 5910int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 5911 5912/** 5913 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 5914 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5915 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 5916 * 5917 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 5918 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 5919 * information. 5920 * 5921 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5922 */ 5923int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5924 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5925 5926/** 5927 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers 5928 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5929 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 5930 * 5931 * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain 5932 * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see 5933 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 5934 * 5935 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5936 */ 5937int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5938 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5939 5940/** 5941 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 5942 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5943 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 5944 * 5945 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 5946 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 5947 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 5948 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 5949 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 5950 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 5951 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 5952 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 5953 * that called this helper. 5954 */ 5955void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5956 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 5957 5958/** 5959 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 5960 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 5961 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 5962 * 5963 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 5964 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 5965 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 5966 * and processed already. 5967 * 5968 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 5969 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 5970 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 5971 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 5972 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 5973 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 5974 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 5975 */ 5976const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5977 u32 center_freq); 5978 5979/** 5980 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 5981 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 5982 * 5983 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 5984 * proper string representation. 5985 */ 5986const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 5987 5988/** 5989 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 5990 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 5991 * 5992 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 5993 */ 5994bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5995 5996/** 5997 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 5998 * 5999 */ 6000 6001/** 6002 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6003 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6004 * 6005 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6006 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 6007 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6008 * 6009 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6010 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6011 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6012 * 6013 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6014 * an -ENODATA. 6015 * 6016 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6017 */ 6018int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6019 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6020 6021/* 6022 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6023 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6024 */ 6025 6026/** 6027 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6028 * 6029 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6030 * @info: information about the completed scan 6031 */ 6032void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6033 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6034 6035/** 6036 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6037 * 6038 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6039 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6040 */ 6041void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6042 6043/** 6044 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6045 * 6046 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6047 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6048 * 6049 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6050 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6051 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6052 */ 6053void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6054 6055/** 6056 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6057 * 6058 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6059 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6060 * 6061 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6062 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6063 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6064 * This function should be called with rtnl locked. 6065 */ 6066void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6067 6068/** 6069 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6070 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6071 * @data: the BSS metadata 6072 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6073 * @len: length of the management frame 6074 * @gfp: context flags 6075 * 6076 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6077 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6078 * 6079 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6080 * Or %NULL on error. 6081 */ 6082struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6083cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6084 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6085 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6086 gfp_t gfp); 6087 6088static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6089cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6090 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6091 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6092 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6093 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6094{ 6095 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6096 .chan = rx_channel, 6097 .scan_width = scan_width, 6098 .signal = signal, 6099 }; 6100 6101 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6102} 6103 6104static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6105cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6106 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6107 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6108 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6109{ 6110 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6111 .chan = rx_channel, 6112 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6113 .signal = signal, 6114 }; 6115 6116 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6117} 6118 6119/** 6120 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6121 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6122 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6123 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6124 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6125 */ 6126static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6127 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6128{ 6129 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6130 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6131 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6132 6133 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6134 6135 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6136 6137 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6138} 6139 6140/** 6141 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6142 * @element: element to check 6143 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6144 */ 6145bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6146 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6147 6148/** 6149 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6150 * @ie: ies 6151 * @ielen: length of IEs 6152 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6153 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6154 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6155 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6156 */ 6157size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6158 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6159 const struct element *sub_elem, 6160 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6161 6162/** 6163 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6164 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6165 * from a beacon or probe response 6166 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6167 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6168 */ 6169enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6170 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6171 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6172 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6173}; 6174 6175/** 6176 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6177 * 6178 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6179 * @data: the BSS metadata 6180 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6181 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6182 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6183 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6184 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6185 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6186 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6187 * @gfp: context flags 6188 * 6189 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6190 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6191 * 6192 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6193 * Or %NULL on error. 6194 */ 6195struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6196cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6197 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6198 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6199 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6200 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6201 gfp_t gfp); 6202 6203static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6204cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6205 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6206 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6207 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6208 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6209 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6210 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6211{ 6212 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6213 .chan = rx_channel, 6214 .scan_width = scan_width, 6215 .signal = signal, 6216 }; 6217 6218 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6219 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6220 gfp); 6221} 6222 6223static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6224cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6225 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6226 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6227 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6228 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6229 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6230{ 6231 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6232 .chan = rx_channel, 6233 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6234 .signal = signal, 6235 }; 6236 6237 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6238 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6239 gfp); 6240} 6241 6242/** 6243 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6244 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6245 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6246 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6247 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6248 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6249 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6250 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6251 */ 6252struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6253 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6254 const u8 *bssid, 6255 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6256 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6257 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6258static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6259cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6260 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6261 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6262{ 6263 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6264 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6265 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6266} 6267 6268/** 6269 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6270 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6271 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6272 * 6273 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6274 */ 6275void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6276 6277/** 6278 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6279 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6280 * @bss: the BSS struct 6281 * 6282 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6283 */ 6284void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6285 6286/** 6287 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6288 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6289 * @bss: the bss to remove 6290 * 6291 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6292 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6293 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6294 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6295 */ 6296void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6297 6298/** 6299 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6300 * 6301 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6302 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6303 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6304 * 6305 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6306 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6307 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6308 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6309 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6310 */ 6311void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6312 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6313 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6314 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6315 void *data), 6316 void *iter_data); 6317 6318static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6319cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6320{ 6321 switch (chandef->width) { 6322 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6323 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6324 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6325 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6326 default: 6327 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6328 } 6329} 6330 6331/** 6332 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6333 * @dev: network device 6334 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6335 * @len: length of the frame data 6336 * 6337 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6338 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6339 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6340 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6341 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6342 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6343 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6344 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6345 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6346 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6347 * 6348 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6349 */ 6350void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6351 6352/** 6353 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6354 * @dev: network device 6355 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6356 * 6357 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6358 * mutex. 6359 */ 6360void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6361 6362/** 6363 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6364 * @dev: network device 6365 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6366 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6367 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6368 * @len: length of the frame data 6369 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6370 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6371 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6372 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6373 * 6374 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6375 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6376 * 6377 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6378 */ 6379void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6380 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6381 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6382 int uapsd_queues, 6383 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6384 6385/** 6386 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6387 * @dev: network device 6388 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6389 * 6390 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6391 */ 6392void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6393 6394/** 6395 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6396 * @dev: network device 6397 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6398 * 6399 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6400 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6401 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6402 */ 6403void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6404 6405/** 6406 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6407 * @dev: network device 6408 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6409 * @len: length of the frame data 6410 * 6411 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6412 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6413 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6414 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6415 */ 6416void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6417 6418/** 6419 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6420 * @dev: network device 6421 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6422 * @len: length of the frame data 6423 * 6424 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6425 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6426 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6427 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6428 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6429 * 6430 * This function may sleep. 6431 */ 6432void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6433 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6434 6435/** 6436 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6437 * @dev: network device 6438 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6439 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6440 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6441 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6442 * @gfp: allocation flags 6443 * 6444 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6445 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6446 * primitive. 6447 */ 6448void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6449 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6450 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6451 6452/** 6453 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6454 * 6455 * @dev: network device 6456 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6457 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6458 * @gfp: allocation flags 6459 * 6460 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6461 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6462 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6463 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6464 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6465 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6466 */ 6467void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6468 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6469 6470/** 6471 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 6472 * candidate 6473 * 6474 * @dev: network device 6475 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6476 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6477 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6478 * @gfp: allocation flags 6479 * 6480 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6481 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6482 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6483 */ 6484void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6485 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6486 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6487 6488/** 6489 * DOC: RFkill integration 6490 * 6491 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6492 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6493 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6494 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6495 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6496 * 6497 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6498 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6499 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6500 */ 6501 6502/** 6503 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6504 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6505 * @blocked: block status 6506 */ 6507void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked); 6508 6509/** 6510 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6511 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6512 */ 6513void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6514 6515/** 6516 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6517 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6518 */ 6519void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6520 6521/** 6522 * DOC: Vendor commands 6523 * 6524 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6525 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6526 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6527 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6528 * the configuration mechanism. 6529 * 6530 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6531 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6532 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6533 * 6534 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6535 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6536 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6537 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6538 * managers etc. need. 6539 */ 6540 6541struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6542 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6543 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6544 int approxlen); 6545 6546struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6547 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6548 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6549 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6550 unsigned int portid, 6551 int vendor_event_idx, 6552 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6553 6554void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6555 6556/** 6557 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6558 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6559 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6560 * be put into the skb 6561 * 6562 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6563 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6564 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6565 * 6566 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6567 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6568 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6569 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6570 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6571 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6572 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6573 * 6574 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6575 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6576 * 6577 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6578 */ 6579static inline struct sk_buff * 6580cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6581{ 6582 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6583 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6584} 6585 6586/** 6587 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6588 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6589 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6590 * 6591 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6592 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6593 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6594 * skb regardless of the return value. 6595 * 6596 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6597 */ 6598int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6599 6600/** 6601 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender 6602 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6603 * 6604 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6605 * Valid to call only there. 6606 */ 6607unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6608 6609/** 6610 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6611 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6612 * @wdev: the wireless device 6613 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6614 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6615 * be put into the skb 6616 * @gfp: allocation flags 6617 * 6618 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6619 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6620 * 6621 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6622 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6623 * attribute. 6624 * 6625 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6626 * skb to send the event. 6627 * 6628 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6629 */ 6630static inline struct sk_buff * 6631cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6632 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6633{ 6634 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6635 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6636 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6637} 6638 6639/** 6640 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6641 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6642 * @wdev: the wireless device 6643 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6644 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6645 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6646 * be put into the skb 6647 * @gfp: allocation flags 6648 * 6649 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6650 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6651 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6652 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6653 * 6654 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6655 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6656 * attribute. 6657 * 6658 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6659 * skb to send the event. 6660 * 6661 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6662 */ 6663static inline struct sk_buff * 6664cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6665 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6666 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6667 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6668{ 6669 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6670 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6671 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6672} 6673 6674/** 6675 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6676 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6677 * @gfp: allocation flags 6678 * 6679 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6680 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6681 */ 6682static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6683{ 6684 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6685} 6686 6687#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6688/** 6689 * DOC: Test mode 6690 * 6691 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6692 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6693 * factory programming. 6694 * 6695 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6696 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6697 */ 6698 6699/** 6700 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6701 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6702 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6703 * be put into the skb 6704 * 6705 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6706 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6707 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6708 * 6709 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6710 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6711 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6712 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6713 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6714 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6715 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6716 * 6717 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6718 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6719 * 6720 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6721 */ 6722static inline struct sk_buff * 6723cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6724{ 6725 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6726 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6727} 6728 6729/** 6730 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6731 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6732 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6733 * 6734 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6735 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6736 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6737 * regardless of the return value. 6738 * 6739 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6740 */ 6741static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6742{ 6743 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6744} 6745 6746/** 6747 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6748 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6749 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6750 * be put into the skb 6751 * @gfp: allocation flags 6752 * 6753 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6754 * testmode multicast group. 6755 * 6756 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6757 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6758 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6759 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6760 * in any other way. 6761 * 6762 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6763 * skb to send the event. 6764 * 6765 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6766 */ 6767static inline struct sk_buff * 6768cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6769{ 6770 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6771 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6772 approxlen, gfp); 6773} 6774 6775/** 6776 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6777 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6778 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6779 * @gfp: allocation flags 6780 * 6781 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6782 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6783 * consumes it. 6784 */ 6785static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6786{ 6787 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6788} 6789 6790#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6791#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6792#else 6793#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6794#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6795#endif 6796 6797/** 6798 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6799 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6800 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6801 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6802 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6803 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6804 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6805 * status for a FILS connection. 6806 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6807 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6808 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6809 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6810 */ 6811struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6812 const u8 *kek; 6813 size_t kek_len; 6814 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 6815 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 6816 const u8 *pmk; 6817 size_t pmk_len; 6818 const u8 *pmkid; 6819}; 6820 6821/** 6822 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 6823 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6824 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6825 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6826 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6827 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6828 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6829 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6830 * case. 6831 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 6832 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6833 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6834 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6835 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6836 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6837 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6838 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 6839 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 6840 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6841 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 6842 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 6843 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6844 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6845 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6846 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6847 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6848 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6849 */ 6850struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 6851 int status; 6852 const u8 *bssid; 6853 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 6854 const u8 *req_ie; 6855 size_t req_ie_len; 6856 const u8 *resp_ie; 6857 size_t resp_ie_len; 6858 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 6859 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 6860}; 6861 6862/** 6863 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6864 * 6865 * @dev: network device 6866 * @params: connection response parameters 6867 * @gfp: allocation flags 6868 * 6869 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6870 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6871 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 6872 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 6873 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 6874 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6875 */ 6876void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 6877 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 6878 gfp_t gfp); 6879 6880/** 6881 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6882 * 6883 * @dev: network device 6884 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6885 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6886 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6887 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6888 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6889 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6890 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6891 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6892 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6893 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6894 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6895 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6896 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6897 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6898 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6899 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6900 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6901 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6902 * case. 6903 * @gfp: allocation flags 6904 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6905 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6906 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6907 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6908 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6909 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6910 * 6911 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6912 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6913 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 6914 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 6915 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6916 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6917 */ 6918static inline void 6919cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6920 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 6921 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 6922 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 6923 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6924{ 6925 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 6926 6927 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 6928 params.status = status; 6929 params.bssid = bssid; 6930 params.bss = bss; 6931 params.req_ie = req_ie; 6932 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 6933 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 6934 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 6935 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 6936 6937 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 6938} 6939 6940/** 6941 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6942 * 6943 * @dev: network device 6944 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6945 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6946 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6947 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6948 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6949 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6950 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6951 * the real status code for failures. 6952 * @gfp: allocation flags 6953 * 6954 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6955 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6956 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 6957 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6958 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6959 */ 6960static inline void 6961cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6962 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 6963 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 6964 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 6965{ 6966 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 6967 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 6968 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 6969} 6970 6971/** 6972 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 6973 * 6974 * @dev: network device 6975 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6976 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6977 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6978 * @gfp: allocation flags 6979 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 6980 * 6981 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 6982 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 6983 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 6984 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 6985 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 6986 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6987 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6988 */ 6989static inline void 6990cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6991 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 6992 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6993{ 6994 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 6995 gfp, timeout_reason); 6996} 6997 6998/** 6999 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7000 * 7001 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 7002 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 7003 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 7004 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7005 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7006 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7007 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7008 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7009 */ 7010struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7011 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 7012 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7013 const u8 *bssid; 7014 const u8 *req_ie; 7015 size_t req_ie_len; 7016 const u8 *resp_ie; 7017 size_t resp_ie_len; 7018 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7019}; 7020 7021/** 7022 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 7023 * 7024 * @dev: network device 7025 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 7026 * @gfp: allocation flags 7027 * 7028 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 7029 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 7030 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 7031 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 7032 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 7033 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 7034 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 7035 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 7036 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 7037 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 7038 */ 7039void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 7040 gfp_t gfp); 7041 7042/** 7043 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 7044 * 7045 * @dev: network device 7046 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7047 * @gfp: allocation flags 7048 * 7049 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7050 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7051 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7052 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7053 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7054 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7055 */ 7056void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7057 gfp_t gfp); 7058 7059/** 7060 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7061 * 7062 * @dev: network device 7063 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7064 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7065 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7066 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7067 * @gfp: allocation flags 7068 * 7069 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7070 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7071 */ 7072void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7073 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7074 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7075 7076/** 7077 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7078 * @wdev: wireless device 7079 * @cookie: the request cookie 7080 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7081 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7082 * channel 7083 * @gfp: allocation flags 7084 */ 7085void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7086 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7087 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7088 7089/** 7090 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7091 * @wdev: wireless device 7092 * @cookie: the request cookie 7093 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7094 * @gfp: allocation flags 7095 */ 7096void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7097 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7098 gfp_t gfp); 7099 7100/** 7101 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7102 * @wdev: wireless device 7103 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7104 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7105 * @gfp: allocation flags 7106 */ 7107void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7108 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7109 7110/** 7111 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7112 * 7113 * @sinfo: the station information 7114 * @gfp: allocation flags 7115 */ 7116int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7117 7118/** 7119 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7120 * @sinfo: the station information 7121 * 7122 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7123 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7124 * the stack.) 7125 */ 7126static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7127{ 7128 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7129} 7130 7131/** 7132 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7133 * 7134 * @dev: the netdev 7135 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7136 * @sinfo: the station information 7137 * @gfp: allocation flags 7138 */ 7139void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7140 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7141 7142/** 7143 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7144 * @dev: the netdev 7145 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7146 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7147 * @gfp: allocation flags 7148 */ 7149void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7150 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7151 7152/** 7153 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7154 * 7155 * @dev: the netdev 7156 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7157 * @gfp: allocation flags 7158 */ 7159static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7160 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7161{ 7162 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7163} 7164 7165/** 7166 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7167 * 7168 * @dev: the netdev 7169 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7170 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7171 * @gfp: allocation flags 7172 * 7173 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7174 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7175 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7176 * 7177 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7178 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7179 */ 7180void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7181 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7182 gfp_t gfp); 7183 7184/** 7185 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7186 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7187 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7188 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7189 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7190 * @len: length of the frame data 7191 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7192 * 7193 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7194 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7195 * 7196 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7197 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7198 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7199 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7200 */ 7201bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7202 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7203 7204/** 7205 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7206 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7207 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7208 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7209 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7210 * @len: length of the frame data 7211 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7212 * 7213 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7214 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7215 * 7216 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7217 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7218 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7219 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7220 */ 7221static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7222 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7223 u32 flags) 7224{ 7225 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7226 flags); 7227} 7228 7229/** 7230 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7231 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7232 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7233 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7234 * @len: length of the frame data 7235 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7236 * @gfp: context flags 7237 * 7238 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7239 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7240 * transmission attempt. 7241 */ 7242void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7243 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7244 7245/** 7246 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7247 * port frames 7248 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7249 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7250 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7251 * @len: length of the frame data 7252 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7253 * @gfp: context flags 7254 * 7255 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7256 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7257 * the transmission attempt. 7258 */ 7259void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7260 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7261 gfp_t gfp); 7262 7263/** 7264 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7265 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7266 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7267 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7268 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7269 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7270 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7271 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7272 * 7273 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7274 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7275 * control port frames over nl80211. 7276 * 7277 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7278 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7279 * 7280 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7281 */ 7282bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7283 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7284 7285/** 7286 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7287 * @dev: network device 7288 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7289 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7290 * @gfp: context flags 7291 * 7292 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7293 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7294 */ 7295void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7296 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7297 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7298 7299/** 7300 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7301 * @dev: network device 7302 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7303 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7304 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7305 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7306 * @gfp: context flags 7307 */ 7308void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7309 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7310 7311/** 7312 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7313 * @dev: network device 7314 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7315 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7316 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7317 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7318 * @gfp: context flags 7319 * 7320 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7321 * given interval is exceeded. 7322 */ 7323void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7324 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7325 7326/** 7327 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7328 * @dev: network device 7329 * @gfp: context flags 7330 * 7331 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7332 */ 7333void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7334 7335/** 7336 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7337 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7338 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7339 * @gfp: context flags 7340 * 7341 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7342 */ 7343void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7344 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7345 7346/** 7347 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7348 * @dev: network device 7349 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7350 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7351 * @gfp: context flags 7352 * 7353 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7354 * frame. 7355 */ 7356void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7357 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7358 gfp_t gfp); 7359 7360/** 7361 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7362 * @netdev: network device 7363 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7364 * @event: type of event 7365 * @gfp: context flags 7366 * 7367 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7368 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7369 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7370 */ 7371void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7372 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7373 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7374 7375 7376/** 7377 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7378 * @dev: network device 7379 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7380 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7381 * @gfp: allocation flags 7382 */ 7383void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7384 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7385 7386/** 7387 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7388 * @dev: network device 7389 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7390 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7391 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7392 * @gfp: allocation flags 7393 */ 7394void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7395 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7396 7397/** 7398 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7399 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7400 * @addr: the transmitter address 7401 * @gfp: context flags 7402 * 7403 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7404 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7405 * sender. 7406 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7407 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7408 */ 7409bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7410 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7411 7412/** 7413 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7414 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7415 * @addr: the transmitter address 7416 * @gfp: context flags 7417 * 7418 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7419 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7420 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7421 * station to avoid event flooding. 7422 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7423 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7424 */ 7425bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7426 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7427 7428/** 7429 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7430 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7431 * @addr: the address of the peer 7432 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7433 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7434 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7435 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7436 * @gfp: allocation flags 7437 */ 7438void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7439 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7440 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7441 7442/** 7443 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7444 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7445 * @frame: the frame 7446 * @len: length of the frame 7447 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7448 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7449 * 7450 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7451 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7452 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7453 */ 7454void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7455 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7456 7457/** 7458 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7459 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7460 * @frame: the frame 7461 * @len: length of the frame 7462 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7463 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7464 * 7465 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7466 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7467 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7468 */ 7469static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7470 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7471 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7472{ 7473 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7474 sig_dbm); 7475} 7476 7477/** 7478 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7479 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7480 * @chandef: the channel definition 7481 * @iftype: interface type 7482 * 7483 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7484 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7485 */ 7486bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7487 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7488 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7489 7490/** 7491 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7492 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7493 * @chandef: the channel definition 7494 * @iftype: interface type 7495 * 7496 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7497 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7498 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7499 * more permissive conditions. 7500 * 7501 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7502 */ 7503bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7504 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7505 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7506 7507/* 7508 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7509 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7510 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7511 * 7512 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7513 * driver context! 7514 */ 7515void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7516 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7517 7518/* 7519 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7520 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7521 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7522 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7523 * 7524 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7525 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7526 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7527 */ 7528void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7529 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7530 u8 count); 7531 7532/** 7533 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7534 * 7535 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7536 * @band: band pointer to fill 7537 * 7538 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7539 */ 7540bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7541 enum nl80211_band *band); 7542 7543/** 7544 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7545 * 7546 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7547 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7548 * 7549 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7550 */ 7551bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7552 u8 *op_class); 7553 7554/** 7555 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7556 * 7557 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7558 * 7559 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7560 */ 7561static inline u32 7562ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7563{ 7564 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7565} 7566 7567/* 7568 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7569 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7570 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7571 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7572 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7573 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7574 * @gfp: allocation flags 7575 * 7576 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7577 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7578 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7579 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7580 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7581 */ 7582void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7583 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7584 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7585 7586/* 7587 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7588 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7589 * 7590 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7591 */ 7592u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7593 7594/** 7595 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7596 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7597 * 7598 * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned, 7599 * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that 7600 * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function 7601 * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by 7602 * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also 7603 * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. 7604 * when the device is unbound from the driver. 7605 * 7606 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7607 */ 7608void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7609 7610/** 7611 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 7612 * @ies: FT IEs 7613 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7614 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7615 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7616 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7617 */ 7618struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7619 const u8 *ies; 7620 size_t ies_len; 7621 const u8 *target_ap; 7622 const u8 *ric_ies; 7623 size_t ric_ies_len; 7624}; 7625 7626/** 7627 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7628 * @netdev: network device 7629 * @ft_event: IE information 7630 */ 7631void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7632 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7633 7634/** 7635 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7636 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7637 * @len: the input length 7638 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7639 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7640 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7641 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7642 * 7643 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7644 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7645 * 7646 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7647 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7648 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7649 */ 7650int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7651 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7652 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7653 7654/** 7655 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7656 * @ies: the IE buffer 7657 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7658 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7659 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7660 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7661 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7662 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7663 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7664 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7665 * 7666 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7667 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7668 * split. 7669 * 7670 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7671 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7672 * 7673 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7674 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7675 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7676 * 7677 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7678 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7679 * of the buffer should be used. 7680 */ 7681size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7682 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7683 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7684 size_t offset); 7685 7686/** 7687 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7688 * @ies: the IE buffer 7689 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7690 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7691 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7692 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7693 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7694 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7695 * 7696 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7697 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7698 * split. 7699 * 7700 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7701 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7702 * 7703 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7704 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7705 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7706 * 7707 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7708 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7709 * of the buffer should be used. 7710 */ 7711static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7712 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7713{ 7714 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7715} 7716 7717/** 7718 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7719 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7720 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7721 * @gfp: allocation flags 7722 * 7723 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7724 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7725 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7726 * else caused the wakeup. 7727 */ 7728void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7729 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7730 gfp_t gfp); 7731 7732/** 7733 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7734 * 7735 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7736 * @gfp: allocation flags 7737 * 7738 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7739 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7740 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7741 */ 7742void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7743 7744/** 7745 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7746 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7747 * 7748 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7749 */ 7750unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7751 7752/** 7753 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7754 * 7755 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7756 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7757 * 7758 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7759 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7760 * the interface combinations. 7761 */ 7762int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7763 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7764 7765/** 7766 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7767 * 7768 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7769 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7770 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7771 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7772 * 7773 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7774 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7775 * purposes. 7776 */ 7777int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7778 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7779 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7780 void *data), 7781 void *data); 7782 7783/* 7784 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7785 * 7786 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7787 * @wdev: wireless device 7788 * @gfp: context flags 7789 * 7790 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 7791 * disconnected. 7792 * 7793 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 7794 */ 7795void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7796 gfp_t gfp); 7797 7798/** 7799 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 7800 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 7801 * 7802 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 7803 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 7804 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 7805 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 7806 * 7807 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 7808 * the driver while the function is running. 7809 */ 7810void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7811 7812/** 7813 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 7814 * 7815 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7816 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7817 * 7818 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7819 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7820 */ 7821static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7822 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7823{ 7824 u8 *ft_byte; 7825 7826 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7827 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 7828} 7829 7830/** 7831 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 7832 * 7833 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7834 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7835 * 7836 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7837 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7838 */ 7839static inline bool 7840wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7841 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7842{ 7843 u8 ft_byte; 7844 7845 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7846 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 7847} 7848 7849/** 7850 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 7851 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 7852 * 7853 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 7854 */ 7855void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 7856 7857/** 7858 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 7859 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 7860 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 7861 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 7862 * result. 7863 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 7864 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7865 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 7866 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 7867 * @info_len: the length of the &info 7868 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 7869 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 7870 */ 7871struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 7872 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 7873 u8 inst_id; 7874 u8 peer_inst_id; 7875 const u8 *addr; 7876 u8 info_len; 7877 const u8 *info; 7878 u64 cookie; 7879}; 7880 7881/** 7882 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 7883 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7884 * @match: match notification parameters 7885 * @gfp: allocation flags 7886 * 7887 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 7888 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 7889 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 7890 */ 7891void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7892 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 7893 7894/** 7895 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7896 * 7897 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7898 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7899 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7900 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 7901 * @gfp: allocation flags 7902 * 7903 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 7904 */ 7905void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7906 u8 inst_id, 7907 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7908 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 7909 7910/* ethtool helper */ 7911void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 7912 7913/** 7914 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 7915 * @netdev: network device 7916 * @params: External authentication parameters 7917 * @gfp: allocation flags 7918 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 7919 */ 7920int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 7921 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 7922 gfp_t gfp); 7923 7924/** 7925 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 7926 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7927 * @req: the original measurement request 7928 * @result: the result data 7929 * @gfp: allocation flags 7930 */ 7931void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7932 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7933 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 7934 gfp_t gfp); 7935 7936/** 7937 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 7938 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7939 * @req: the original measurement request 7940 * @gfp: allocation flags 7941 * 7942 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 7943 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 7944 */ 7945void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7946 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7947 gfp_t gfp); 7948 7949/** 7950 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 7951 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7952 * @iftype: interface type 7953 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 7954 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 7955 * 7956 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 7957 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 7958 * check_swif is '1'. 7959 */ 7960bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 7961 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 7962 7963 7964/* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 7965 7966/* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 7967 7968#define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 7969 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7970#define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7971 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7972#define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7973 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7974#define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7975 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7976#define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7977 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7978#define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7979 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7980#define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7981 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7982#define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7983 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7984 7985#define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7986 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7987#define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7988 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7989 7990#define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7991 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 7992 7993#define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7994 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7995 7996#if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 7997#define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 7998#else 7999#define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8000({ \ 8001 if (0) \ 8002 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 8003 0; \ 8004}) 8005#endif 8006 8007/* 8008 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 8009 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 8010 * file/line information and a backtrace. 8011 */ 8012#define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8013 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 8014 8015/** 8016 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 8017 * @netdev: network device 8018 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 8019 * @gfp: allocation flags 8020 */ 8021void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8022 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 8023 gfp_t gfp); 8024 8025/** 8026 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 8027 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8028 */ 8029void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8030 8031#endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 8032